750 PowerFlexInversor
750 PowerFlexInversor
750 PowerFlexInversor
USER MANUAL
Important User Information Solid state equipment has operational characteristics differing from those of
electromechanical equipment. Safety Guidelines for the Application,
Installation and Maintenance of Solid State Controls (Publication SGI-1.1
available from your local Rockwell Automation sales office or online at http://
www.rockwellautomation.com/literature) describes some important differences
between solid state equipment and hard-wired electromechanical devices.
Because of this difference, and also because of the wide variety of uses for solid
state equipment, all persons responsible for applying this equipment must
satisfy themselves that each intended application of this equipment is
acceptable.
In no event will Rockwell Automation, Inc. be responsible or liable for indirect
or consequential damages resulting from the use or application of this
equipment.
The examples and diagrams in this manual are included solely for illustrative
purposes. Because of the many variables and requirements associated with any
particular installation, Rockwell Automation, Inc. cannot assume responsibility
or liability for actual use based on the examples and diagrams.
No patent liability is assumed by Rockwell Automation, Inc. with respect to use
of information, circuits, equipment, or software described in this manual.
Reproduction of the contents of this manual, in whole or in part, without
written permission of Rockwell Automation, Inc. is prohibited.
Throughout this manual, when necessary we use notes to make you aware of
safety considerations.
PowerFlex, DriveExplorer, DriveExecutive, DPI, and SCANport are either trademarks or registered trademarks of Rockwell Automation, Inc.
This Manual This is the first release of the PowerFlex 750-Series User Manual.
Preface Overview
Who Should Use This Manual . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . P-1
What Is Not In This Manual . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . P-1
Recommended Documentation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . P-1
Obtaining Manuals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . P-2
Allen-Bradley Drives Technical Support . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . P-2
Product Certification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . P-2
Manual Conventions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . P-3
Drive Frame Sizes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . P-3
General Precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . P-4
Catalog Number Explanation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . P-6
Chapter 1 Installation/Wiring
Chapter Objectives . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-1
Opening the Cover . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-2
Mounting Considerations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-4
AC Supply Source Considerations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-5
Grounding Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-6
Fuses and Circuit Breakers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-8
Power Wiring. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-8
IP65, NEMA Type 12 Installations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-15
Using Input/Output Contactors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-16
Using PowerFlex 750-Series Drives with Regenerative Power Units. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-17
Drive Power Jumper Configuration. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-17
I/O Wiring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-22
Option Module Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-28
I/O Module . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-29
Safe Torque Off Option Module . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-33
Safe Speed Monitor Option Module . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-34
Auxiliary Power Supply Option Module . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-35
DeviceNet Option Module . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-35
20-COMM Carrier . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-36
Using 750-Series Drives with Regen Power Units . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-36
CE Conformity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-37
Chapter 2 Start Up
Chapter Objectives . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-1
Establishing A Connection With EtherNet/IP. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-2
Prepare For Drive Start-Up . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-4
Start-Up Menu. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-5
Status Indicators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-6
Chapter 4 Troubleshooting
Faults and Alarms . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1
Drive Status . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-2
Manually Clearing Faults. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-2
HIM Indication . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-3
Fault and Alarm Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-4
Common Symptoms and Corrective Actions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-10
Index
Overview
The purpose of this manual is to provide you with the basic information
needed to install, start-up and troubleshoot PowerFlex® 750-Series
Adjustable Frequency AC Drives.
For information on … See page...
Who Should Use This Manual P-1
What Is Not In This Manual P-1
Recommended Documentation P-1
Manual Conventions P-3
Drive Frame Sizes P-3
General Precautions P-4
Catalog Number Explanation P-6
Who Should Use This This manual is intended for qualified personnel. You must be able to
Manual program and operate Adjustable Frequency AC Drive devices. In addition,
you must have an understanding of the parameter settings and functions.
What Is Not In This Manual The PowerFlex 750-Series User Manual is designed to provide only basic
start-up information. For detailed information on drive application, please
refer to the PowerFlex 750-Series Reference Manual. The reference manual
is available online at www.rockwellautomation.com/literature.
Obtaining Manuals To order paper copies of technical documentation, contact your local
Rockwell Automation distributor or sales representative.
Allen-Bradley Drives
Online at… By Email at… By Telephone at…
Technical Support
www.ab.com/support/abdrives support@drives.ra.rockwell.com 262-512-8176
Product Certification Product Certifications and Declarations of Conformity are available on the
internet at: www.rockwellautomation.com/products/certification
• To help differentiate parameter names and LCD display text from other
text, the following conventions will be used:
Drive Frame Sizes Similar PowerFlex 750-Series drive sizes are grouped into frame sizes to
simplify spare parts ordering, dimensioning, etc. A cross reference of drive
catalog numbers and their respective frame size is provided in Appendix A.
Personal Safety
ATTENTION: To avoid an electric shock hazard, verify that the
! voltage on the bus capacitors has discharged completely before
servicing. Check the DC bus voltage at the Power Terminal
Block by measuring between the +DC and -DC terminals (refer
to Chapter 1 for location), between the +DC terminal and the
chassis, and between the -DC terminal and the chassis. The
voltage must be zero for all three measurements.
ATTENTION: Hazard of personal injury or equipment damage
! exists when using bipolar input sources. Noise and drift in
sensitive input circuits can cause unpredictable changes in motor
speed and direction. Use speed command parameters to help
reduce input source sensitivity.
ATTENTION: Risk of injury or equipment damage exists. DPI
! or SCANport host products must not be directly connected
together via 1202 cables. Unpredictable behavior can result if
two or more devices are connected in this manner.
ATTENTION: The drive start/stop/enable control circuitry
! includes solid state components. If hazards due to accidental
contact with moving machinery or unintentional flow of liquid,
gas or solids exists, an additional hardwired stop circuit may be
required to remove the AC line to the drive. An auxiliary braking
method may be required.
ATTENTION: Hazard of personal injury or equipment damage
! due to unexpected machine operation exists if the drive is
configured to automatically issue a Start or Run command. Do
not use these functions without considering applicable local,
national and international codes, standards, regulations or
industry guidelines.
Product Safety
ATTENTION: An incorrectly applied or installed drive can
! result in component damage or a reduction in product life.
Wiring or application errors such as under sizing the motor,
incorrect or inadequate AC supply, or excessive surrounding air
temperatures may result in malfunction of the system.
ATTENTION: This drive contains ESD (Electrostatic
! Discharge) sensitive parts and assemblies. Static control
precautions are required when installing, testing, servicing or
repairing this assembly. Component damage may result if ESD
control procedures are not followed. If you are not familiar with
static control procedures, reference Guarding Against
Electrostatic Damage, publication 8000-4.5.2 or any other
applicable ESD protection handbook.
ATTENTION: Configuring an analog input for 0-20 mA
! operation and driving it from a voltage source could cause
component damage. Verify proper configuration prior to
applying input signals.
ATTENTION: A contactor or other device that routinely
! disconnects and reapplies the AC line to the drive to start and
stop the motor can cause drive hardware damage. The drive is
designed to use control input signals that will start and stop the
motor. If an input device is used, operation must not exceed one
cycle per minute or drive damage will occur.
20G 1 1 N D 248 A A 0 N N N N N
a b c d e f g h
a f1 g
Drive ND Rating Filtering and CM Cap Configuration
Code Type 400V, 50 Hz Input Default CM Cap
Code Filtering
20G PowerFlex 755 Frame Connection
Enclosure A Yes Jumper Removed
Code Amps kW Enclosure
Codes F J Yes Jumper Installed
b Code G
and N In all cases, jumpers are included for field
Future Use 015 15.4 7.5 2 2 reconfiguration as desired.
022 22 11 2 2
c 030 30 15 3 3 h
037 37 18.5 3 3
Input Type Dynamic Braking
043 43 22 3 3
Code Description Frames Internal Resistor Internal Transistor
060 60 30 4 4 Code
1 6 Pulse, w/DC Terminals 2…7
A 6 Pulse, w/o DC Terminals 6, 7 072 72 37 4 5 A No Yes
085 85 45 5 5 B Yes Yes
104 104 55 5 – N No No
d 140 140 75 6 – Frame 2 only.
Enclosure 170 170 90 6 – Standard on Frames 2…5, Optional on
Code Description 205 205 110 6 – Frames 6…7.
F Flange (NEMA/UL Type 4X back) § ‡ 260 260 132 6 –
G IP54, NEMA/UL Type 12 § 302 302 160 7 – 750-Series Drive Options
N IP20/IP00, NEMA/UL Type Open 367 367 200 7 –
Description Cat. No.
‡ Frames 6…7 User Installed Flange Kit (see [R- 456 456 250 7 –
1826961]) provides a NEMA/UL Type 4X back. 24V I/O Module - 2AI,
20-750-2262C-2R
2AO, 6DI, 2RO
§ Frames 2…5 only.
Frames 2…5 are IP20, Frames 6…7 are IP00. f2 115V I/O Module - 2AI,
20-750-2262D-2R
2AO, 6DI, 2RO
ND Rating
24V I/O Module - 2AI,
480V, 60 Hz Input 20-750-2263C-1R2T
e 2AO, 6DI, 1RO, 2TO
Frame Incremental Encoder 20-750-ENC-1
Voltage Rating
Code Amps Hp Enclosure Dual Incremental
Code Voltage Enclosure 20-750-DENC-1
Codes F Encoder
C 400V AC Code G
and N
Universal Feedback 20-750-UFB-1
D 480V AC 014 14 10 2 2
24V Auxiliary Power
022 22 15 2 2 20-750-APS
Supply
027 27 20 3 3
Safe Torque Off 20-750-S
034 34 25 3 3
Safe Speed Monitor 20-750-S1
040 40 30 3 3
DeviceNet
052 52 40 4 4 20-750-DNET
Communication
065 65 50 4 5 20COMM Carrier 20-750-20COMM
077 77 60 5 5 PowerFlex 7-Class
20-750-HIM-A6
096 96 75 5 – Enhanced HIM, NEMA 1
125 125 100 6 – PowerFlex 7-Class
Remote Enhanced HIM, 20-750-HIM-C6S
156 156 125 6 –
NEMA 4X/12
186 186 150 6 –
248 248 200 6 –
302 302 250 7 –
361 361 300 7 –
415 415 350 7 –
Installation/Wiring
Chapter Objectives This chapter provides the information needed to mount and wire
PowerFlex® 750-Series AC drives, frames 2…7.
Most start-up difficulties are the result of incorrect wiring. Every precaution
must be taken to assure that the wiring is done as instructed. All items must
be read and understood before the actual installation begins.
Opening the Cover Figure 1.1 IP20, NEMA/UL Open Type, Frames 2…5
2x:
M4 X 0.7
90°
AC Supply Source PowerFlex 750-Series drives are suitable for use on a circuit capable of
Considerations delivering up to a maximum of 200,000 rms symmetrical amperes, 480 volts
with recommended fuses/circuit breakers.
If phase to ground voltage will exceed 125% of normal line to line voltage
or the supply system is ungrounded, refer to Wiring and Grounding
Guidelines for Pulse Width Modulated (PWM) AC Drives, publication
DRIVES-IN001.
Certain events on the power system supplying a drive can cause component
damage or shortened product life. These conditions are divided into 2 basic
categories:
1. All Drives
– The power system has power factor correction capacitors switched in
and out of the system, either by the user or by the power company.
– The nearest supply transformer is larger than 100 kVA or the available
short circuit (fault) current is greater than 100,000A.
– The impedance in front of the drive is less than 0.5%.
Grounding Requirements The drive Safety Ground-PE must be connected to system ground.
Ground impedance must conform to the requirements of national and local
industrial safety regulations and/or electrical codes. The integrity of all
ground connections should be periodically checked.
For installations within a cabinet, a single safety ground point or ground bus
bar connected directly to building steel should be used. All circuits
including the AC input ground conductor should be grounded
independently and directly to this point/bar.
R (L1) U (T1)
S (L2) V (T2)
T (L3) W (T3)
PE
SHLD
The Shield terminal (see page 1-12) provides a grounding point for the
motor cable shield. It must be connected to an earth ground by a separate
continuous lead. The motor cable shield should be connected to this
terminal on the drive (drive end) and the motor frame (motor end). Use a
shield terminating or EMI clamp to connect shield to this terminal.
Using an optional RFI filter may result in relatively high ground leakage
currents. Therefore, the filter must only be used in installations with
grounded AC supply systems and be permanently installed and solidly
grounded (bonded) to the building power distribution ground. Ensure that
the incoming supply neutral is solidly connected (bonded) to the same
building power distribution ground. Grounding must not rely on flexible
cables and should not include any form of plug or socket that would permit
inadvertent disconnection. Some local codes may require redundant ground
connections. The integrity of all connections should be periodically
checked. Refer to the instructions supplied with the filter.
Fuses and Circuit Breakers PowerFlex 750-Series drives can be installed with either input fuses or an
input circuit breaker. National and local industrial safety regulations and/or
electrical codes may determine additional requirements for these
installations. Refer to Appendix A for recommended fuses/circuit breakers.
Power Wiring Most start-up difficulties are the result of incorrect wiring. Every precaution
must be taken to assure that the wiring is done as instructed. All items must
be read and understood before the actual installation begins.
A variety of cable types are acceptable for drive installations. For many
installations, unshielded cable is adequate, provided it can be separated
from sensitive circuits. As an approximate guide, allow a spacing of 0.3
meters (1 foot) for every 10 meters (32.8 feet) of length. In all cases, long
parallel runs must be avoided. Do not use cable with an insulation thickness
less than or equal to 15 mils (0.4mm/0.015 in.). Use copper wire only. Wire
gauge requirements and recommendations are based on 75 °C. Do not
reduce wire gauge when using higher temperature wire.
Unshielded
Shielded/Armored Cable
Shielded cable may also help reduce shaft voltage and induced bearing
currents for some applications. In addition, the increased impedance of
shielded cable may help extend the distance the motor can be located from
the drive without the addition of motor protective devices such as terminator
networks. Refer to “Reflected Wave” in Wiring and Grounding Guidelines
for Pulse Width Modulated (PWM) AC Drives, publication
DRIVES-IN001.
Other types of shielded cable are available, but the selection of these types
may limit the allowable cable length. Particularly, some of the newer cables
twist 4 conductors of THHN wire and wrap them tightly with a foil shield.
This construction can greatly increase the cable charging current required
and reduce the overall drive performance. Unless specified in the individual
distance tables as tested with the drive, these cables are not recommended
and their performance against the lead length limits supplied is not known.
EMC Compliance
Typically, motor lead lengths less than 30 meters (100 feet) are acceptable.
However, if your application dictates longer lengths, refer to Wiring and
Grounding Guidelines for Pulse Width Modulated (PWM) AC Drives for
details.
Motor Considerations
➌ ➌
➎
➊ ➋ ➊
Frame 2 ➋
Frame 3
➌ ➊
➋ ➊
Frame 4
➋
Frame 5
Figure 1.7 Typical Terminal Block Location and Termination Points (continued)
➌
➍
➊ ➋
Frame 6
➎
➌
➊
➋
Frame 7
L1 L2 L3 BR BR + - T1 T2 T3
R S T 1 2 DC DC U V W
3
L1 L2 L3 BR BR + - T1 T2 T3
R S T 1 2 DC DC U V W
4
6 (1)
7 (1)
(1) DC Bus Terminals are optional on Frame 6 and 7 drives: catalog number position 5.
Dynamic Brake Resistor Terminals are optional on Frame 6 and 7 drives: catalog number position 12.
Refer to Catalog Number Explanation on page Preface-6.
IP65, NEMA Type 12 Use the plugs supplied with IP65 (NEMA Type 12) rated drives to seal
Installations unused holes in the conduit entry plate.
Important: Completely seat the plug inner rim for the best seal.
Using PowerFlex 750-Series If a Regenerative unit (i.e., 1336 REGEN) is used as a bus supply or a brake,
Drives with Regenerative the common mode capacitors should be disconnected (see Drive Power
Power Units Jumper Configuration).
Drive Power Jumper PowerFlex 750-Series drives contain protective MOVs and common mode
Configuration capacitors that are referenced to ground. To guard against drive damage
and/or operation problems, these devices must be properly configured
according to Table 1.H.
1 1
PE–A
PE–B
DC–
When power Jumper screws are not used, they are stored on the left interior
chassis wall as shown.
Figure 1.10 Typical Frame 2…5 Jumper Screw Storage Location (Frame 4 shown)
• Recommended torque = 1.36 N•m (12.0 lb•in) +/- 0.14 N•m (1.2 lb•in)
• Recommended screwdriver = 6.4 mm (0.25 in.) flat or
T15 Hexalobular
Figure 1.11 Typical Frame 2…5 Jumper Screw Installation Locations (Frame 4
shown)
Connected Disconnected
Connected Disconnected
Common Mode
MOV
Common Mode
MOV
Frames 2…5
Frames 6…7
All Frames
➊
➋
➎
➏
➐
➑
+24V
+24V +24 Volt Power Connections for drive supplied 24V power.
24VC 24VC 24 Volt Common
The main control module has one digital input that can be used as a general
purpose programmmable input, or by removal of a jumper, configured as a
dedicated hardware enable, which is unaffected by parameter settings. To
configure the input as a dedicated hardware enable, complete the following
steps.
2. Locate and remove Jumper J1 ENABLE on the Main Control Board (see
diagram).
J1
The drive ships with the safety enable jumper (J2 SAFETY) installed. This
jumper must be removed when using the safe torque off or speed monitoring
safety options.
Important: Failure to remove the jumper will cause the drive to fault when
a start command is issued.
J2
Option Module Installation Compatible port locations may be restricted for each module. An
icon with position number(s) is provided to indicate which option
module ports are compatible. For example, the icon to the right
indicates that the option module is only compatible with port 4.
1. Firmly press the module edge connector into the desired port.
I/O Module
Table 1.L Input Mode Jumpers
Jumper
Position Voltage Mode Current Mode
20-750-2262C-2R
20-750-2262D-2R
Ai1 Ai1
20-750-2263C-1R2T
Ai0 Ai0
Table 1.O TB2 Terminal Designations (1 Relay and 2 Transistor Outputs: IR2T)
Relay Out Terminal Name Description
R0NO Relay 0 N.O. Output Relay 0 normally open contact.
R0NO R0C Relay 0 Common Output Relay 0 common.
R0C
Parameter Access
Parameter Descriptions
Safe Torque Off Option The safe torque off option is just one component in a safety control system.
Module Components in the system must be chosen and applied appropriately to
achieve the desired level of operational safety. For detailed information on
applying this option, refer to the PowerFlex 750-Series Safe Torque Off
User Manual, publication 750-UM002.
Safe Speed Monitor Option The Safe Speed Monitor option is just one component in a safety control
Module system. Components in the system must be chosen and applied
appropriately to achieve the desired level of operational safety. For detailed
information on applying this option, refer to the Safe Speed Monitor Option
Module for PowerFlex 750-Series AC Drives Safety Reference Manual,
publication 750-RM001.
S21
S21
Table 1.S TB2 Terminal Designations
Related
Terminal Name Description Param
S34 Res0 Reset
52 Dco1 Door Control Output. 74
51 Dco0 Enables pulse testing.
78 Slo1 Safe Limited Speed Output. 73
68 Slo0 Enables pulse testing.
44 Sso1 Safe Stop Output. 72
34 Sso0 Enables pulse testing.
X42 Lmi1 Lock Monitoring Input 60
X32 Lmi0
S34
52
S42 Dmi1 Door Monitoring Input 58
51
78
68
S32 Dmi0
44
34 S62 Sli1 Safe Limited Speed Input 52
X42
X32
S42
S52 Sli0
S32
Important: When the Safe Speed Monitor option is used with the Dual
Incremental Encoder option, both modules must be installed on
the same backplane (ports 6, 5, 4).
Parameter Access
Parameter Descriptions
DeviceNet Option Module For complete information on the DeviceNet Option Module, refer to the
PowerFlex 750-Series Drive DeviceNet Option Module User Manual,
publication 750COM-UM002.
20-COMM Carrier
Enables use of some 20-COMM adapters with PowerFlex 750-Series drives. See .
20-750-20COMM Refer to publication 750COMM-IN001 for instructions on installing a 20-COMM adapter on the
20-COMM Carrier.
Using 750-Series Drives If a Regenerative unit (i.e., 1336 REGEN) is used as a bus supply or a brake,
with Regen Power Units the common mode capacitors should be disconnected. Refer to page 1-17
for information on removing common mode capacitors.
General Considerations
• For CE compliance, drives must satisfy installation requirements related
to both EN 61800-5-1 and EN 61800-3 provided in this document.
• PowerFlex 750-Series AC Drives comply with the EMC requirements of
EN 61800-3 when installed according to good EMC practices and the
instructions provided in this document. However, many factors can
influence the EMC compliance of an entire machine or installation, and
compliance of the drive itself does not ensure compliance of all
applications.
• PowerFlex 750-Series drives are not intended to be used on public
low-voltage networks which supply domestic premises. Without
additional mitigation, radio frequency interference is expected if used on
such a network. The installer is responsible to take measures such as
supplementary line filters and enclosures to prevent interference, in
addition to the installation requirements of this document.
• Requirements for supplementary mitigation related to specific high
frequency emission limits are provided in Table 1.X.
or
Start Up
Chapter Objectives This chapter provides the information needed to start up the PowerFlex®
750-Series drive.
For Information on … See Page...
Prepare For Drive Start-Up 2-4
Start-Up Menu 2-5
Status Indicators 2-6
Establishing A Connection There are three methods for configuring the embedded EtherNet/IP
With EtherNet/IP adapter’s IP address:
See Figure 2.1 and its accompanying table for all possible switch settings
and their related descriptions.
Important: When using the adapter rotary switches, set the IP address
before power is applied because the adapter uses the IP
address it detects when it first receives power.
4 5 6
Hundreds
2 3
7 8
Position 1 9
0
4 5 6
Tens
2 3
7 8
Position 9
1
0
4 5 6
Ones
2 3
7 8
Position 9
1
0
❏ 2. Verify that AC line power at the disconnect device is within the rated
value of the drive.
If the STS LED is not flashing green at this point, refer to Status
Indicators on page 2-6.
❏ 9. Press the Enter key. Follow the menu using the Enter key which will step
you through the Start-Up routine.
The Start-Up routine asks simple questions and prompts you to input
required information.
Start-Up Menu The General Start-Up menu is displayed by default upon initial power up of
the drive.
General Startup
Motor Control Motor Data Feedback Limits Tests Reference I/O Done
Feedback Ref, Ramp, Return to
Motor Ctrl Motor Data Limits Tests I/O
Config Stop Main Menu
Ref, Ramp,
Motor Ctrl Motor Data Fdbk Cnfg Limits Tests I/O
Stop
Return Return Return Return Return Return
Return
Return to
Main Menu
5
0
6
3 continues to run.
Red Flashing A major fault has occurred. Drive will stop. Drive cannot be
started until fault condition is cleared.
Steady A non-resettable fault has occurred.
Red / Flashing A minor fault has occurred. Use parameter 950 [Minor Flt
Yellow Alternately Config] to enable. If not enabled acts like a major fault. When
running, drive continues to run. System is brought to a stop
under system control. Fault must be cleared to continue.
Yellow / Flashing When running, a type 1 alarm condition exists.
Green Alternately
Green / Flashing Drive is flash upgrading.
Red Alternately
ENET Unlit Off The embedded EtherNet/IP adapter and/or network is not
powered, the adapter is not properly connected to the network,
or the adapter needs an IP address.
Red Steady The embedded EtherNet/IP adapter failed the duplicate IP
address detection test.
Red Flashing An EtherNet/IP connection has timed out.
Red / Flashing The embedded EtherNet/IP adapter is performing a self-test.
Green
Green Flashing The embedded EtherNet/IP adapter is properly connected but is
not communicating with any devices on the network.
Green Steady The embedded EtherNet/IP adapter is properly connected and
communicating on the network.
LINK Unlit Off The embedded EtherNet/IP adapter is not powered or is not
transmitting on the network.
Green Flashing The embedded EtherNet/IP adapter is transmitting on the
network.
Important: The Status Indicator LEDs on the drive cover do not indicate
the current status of an installed Communication Adapter
option. If an optional Communication Adapter is installed, refer
to that option’s user manual for a description of LED location
and indication.
About Parameters To configure a drive module to operate in a specific way, certain drive
parameters may have to be configured appropriately. Three types of
parameters exist:
• ENUM Parameters
These parameters allow a selection from 2 or more items. The LCD HIM
will display a text message for each item.
• Bit Parameters
These parameters have individual bits associated with features or
conditions. If the bit is 0, the feature is off or the condition is false. If the
bit is 1, the feature is on or the condition is true.
• Numeric Parameters
These parameters have a single numeric value (i.e. 0.1 Volts).
The example on the following page shows how each parameter type is
presented in this manual.
Read-Write
Data Type
Name
No. Description Values
Vector Regulator Motor Data
Status of the digital input(s) resident on the main control board (Port 0).
Digital In 0
Options
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Default 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Reserved
0 0 0 = Condition False
Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 1 = Condition True
Read-Write
Data Type
Name
No. Description
➊ No. - Parameter Number
RW
RO
Indicates parameter data type (i.e. integer, floating point, boolean). 32-bit
Integer
How Drive Parameters are DriveExecutive programming software displays parameters in “Linear List”
Organized or “File Group Parameter” format. Viewing the parameters in “File Group
Parameter” format simplifies programming by grouping parameters that are
used for similar functions. There are eleven files. Each file is divided into
multiple groups of parameters.
Motor Control Motor Data Motor NP Volts 25 Motor NP Hertz 27 Mtr NP Pwr Units 29 Motor Poles 31
Motor
Motor NP Amps 26 Motor NP RPM 28 Motor NP Power 30
Contr
ol
Mtr Ctrl Options Motor Ctrl Mode 35 Maximum Voltage 36 PWM Frequency 38
Maximum Freq 37
Volts per Hertz VHz Curve 65
Autotune Autotune 70 Autotune Torque 71
Feedback & IO Digin Functions Digital In Conf 150 DI Jog 1 166 DI Accel 2 179
Feedba DI Enable 155 DI Jog 1 Forward 167 DI Decel 2 180
ck and
IO DI Clear Fault 156 DI Jog 1 Reverse 168
DI Aux Fault 157 DI Jog 2 169
DI Stop 158 DI Jog 2 Forward 170
DI Cur Lmt Stop 159 DI Jog 2 Reverse 171
DI Coast Stop 160 DI Manual Ctrl 172
DI Start 161 DI Speed Sel 0 173
DI Fwd Reverse 162 DI Speed Sel 1 174
DI Run 163 DI Speed Sel 2 175
DI Run Forward 164
DI Run Reverse 165
Control Board IO Digital In Sts 220
Drive Cfg Preferences Speed Units 300
Drive
Access Level 301
Config
Language 302
Control Cfg Voltage Class 305 SpdTrqPsn Mode A 309
Duty Rating 306
Direction Mode 308
Auto Manual Ctrl Logic Mask 324 Alt Man Ref Sel 328 Manual Preload 331
Auto Mask 325 Alt Man Ref AnHi 329
Manual Cmd Mask 326 Alt Man Ref AnLo 330
Manual Ref Mask 327
Braking Features Stop Mode A 370 DB Resistor Type 382
Stop Mode B 371 DB Ext Ohms 383
Bus Reg Mode A 372 DB Ext Watts 384
Bus Reg Mode B 373 DB ExtPulseWatts 385
Protection Motor Overload Motor OL Actn 410 Mtr OL Factor 413 Mtr OL Reset Lvl 415
Prote
Mtr OL at Pwr Up 411 Mtr OL Hertz 414 MtrOL Reset Time 416
ction
Mtr OL Alarm Lvl 412
Load Limits Current Lmt Sel 421 Shear Pin Cfg 434 Power Loss Actn 449
Current Limit 1 422 Shear Pin 1 Actn 435
Shear Pin1 Level 436
Shear Pin 1 Time 437
Power Loss Pwr Loss Mode A 450
Motor Control Motor Data Motor NP Volts 25 Motor NP Hertz 27 Mtr NP Pwr Units 29 Motor Poles 31
Motor
Motor NP Amps 26 Motor NP RPM 28 Motor NP Power 30
Contr
ol
Mtr Ctrl Options Motor Ctrl Mode 35 Flux Up Enable 43
Maximum Voltage 36 Flux Up Time 44
Maximum Freq 37
PWM Frequency 38
Mtr Options Cnfg 40
Volts per Hertz Start/Acc Boost 60 Break Voltage 62 VHz Curve 65
Run Boost 61 Break Frequency 63
Autotune Autotune 70 Total Inertia 76
Autotune Torque 71 Inertia Test Lmt 77
IR Voltage Drop 73
Ixo Voltage Drop 74
Flux Current Ref 75
Feedback & IO Digin Functions Digital In Conf 150 DI Jog 1 166 DI Accel 2 179 DI PID Reset 193
Feedba DI Enable 155 DI Jog 1 Forward 167 DI Decel 2 180 DI PID Invert 194
ck and
IO DI Clear Fault 156 DI Jog 1 Reverse 168 DI SpTqPs Sel 0 181 DI Torque StptA 195
DI Aux Fault 157 DI Jog 2 169 DI SpTqPs Sel 1 182 DI Fwd End Limit 196
DI Stop 158 DI Jog 2 Forward 170 DI Stop Mode B 185 DI Fwd Dec Limit 197
DI Cur Lmt Stop 159 DI Jog 2 Reverse 171 DI BusReg Mode B 186 DI Rev End Limit 198
DI Coast Stop 160 DI Manual Ctrl 172 DI PwrLoss ModeB 187 DI Rev Dec Limit 199
DI Start 161 DI Speed Sel 0 173 DI Pwr Loss 188 DI PHdwr OvrTrvl 200
DI Fwd Reverse 162 DI Speed Sel 1 174 DI Precharge 189 DI NHdwr OvrTrvl 201
DI Run 163 DI Speed Sel 2 175 DI Prchrg Seal 190
DI Run Forward 164 DI MOP Inc 177 DI PID Enable 191
DI Run Reverse 165 DI MOP Dec 178 DI PID Hold 192
Control Board IO Digital In Sts 220
Drive Cfg Preferences Speed Units 300
Drive
Access Level 301
Config
Language 302
Control Cfg Voltage Class 305 SpdTrqPsn Mode A 309 Actv SpTqPs Mode 313 Prchrg Control 321
Duty Rating 306 SpdTrqPsn Mode B 310 SLAT Err Stpt 314 Prchrg Delay 322
Direction Mode 308 SpdTrqPsn Mode C 311 SLAT Dwell Time 315 Prchrg Err Cfg 323
SpdTrqPsn Mode D 312 Logic Mask 324
Auto Manual Ctrl Auto Mask 325 Alt Man Ref Sel 328 Manual Preload 331
Manual Cmd Mask 326 Alt Man Ref AnHi 329
Manual Ref Mask 327 Alt Man Ref AnLo 330
Drive Memory Reset Meters 336
Start Features Start At PowerUp 345 Sleep Wake Mode 350 FlyingStart Mode 356
PowerUp Delay 346 SleepWake RefSel 351
Auto Retry Fault 347 Sleep Level 352
Auto Rstrt Tries 348 Sleep Time 353
Auto Rstrt Delay 349 Wake Level 354
Wake Time 355
Braking Features Stop Mode A 370 DB Resistor Type 382 DC Brake Lvl Sel 393 Fast Braking Kp 401
Stop Mode B 371 DB Ext Ohms 383 DC Brake Level 394 Brake Off Adj 1 402
Bus Reg Mode A 372 DB Ext Watts 384 DC Brake Time 395 Brake Off Adj 2 403
Bus Reg Mode B 373 DB ExtPulseWatts 385 Dec Inhibit Actn 409
Bus Reg Lvl Cnfg 374 Flux Braking En 388
Bus Reg Level 375 Flux Braking Lmt 389
Motor Control Motor Data Motor NP Volts 25 Motor NP Hertz 27 Mtr NP Pwr Units 29 Motor Poles 31
Motor
Motor NP Amps 26 Motor NP RPM 28 Motor NP Power 30
Contr
ol
Mtr Ctrl Options Motor Ctrl Mode 35 Bus Utilization 42 Econ At Ref Ki 47 Stab Volt Gain 51
Maximum Voltage 36 Flux Up Enable 43 Econ AccDec Ki 48 Stab Angle Gain 52
Maximum Freq 37 Flux Up Time 44 Econ AccDec Kp 49
PWM Frequency 38 Flux Down Ki 45 Stability Filter 50
Mtr Options Cnfg 40 Flux Down Kp 46
Volts per Hertz Start/Acc Boost 60 Break Voltage 62 SVC Boost Filter 64
Run Boost 61 Break Frequency 63 VHz Curve 65
Autotune Autotune 70 Total Inertia 76 PM PriEnc Offset 81 PM IR Voltage 87
Autotune Torque 71 Inertia Test Lmt 77 PM AltEnc Offset 82 PM IXq Voltage 88
IR Voltage Drop 73 Encdrlss AngComp 78 PM OfstTst Cur 83 PM IXd Voltage 89
Ixo Voltage Drop 74 Encdrlss VltComp 79 PM OfstTst CRamp 84 PM Vqs Reg Kp 91
Flux Current Ref 75 PM Cfg 80 PM OfstTst FRamp 85 PM Vqs Reg Ki 92
PM CEMF Voltage 86 PM Dir Test Cur 93
Vector Regulator VCL Cur Reg BW 95 Slip Reg Ki 101 Trq Adapt En 107 SFAdapt SlewLmt 113
VCL Cur Reg Kp 96 Slip Reg Kp 102 Phase Delay Comp 108 SFAdapt SlewRate 114
VCL Cur Reg Ki 97 Flux Reg Enable 103 Trq Comp Mode 109 SFAdapt CnvrgLvl 115
VEncdls FReg Kp 98 Flux Reg Ki 104 Trq Comp Mtring 110 SFAdapt CnvrgLmt 116
VEncdls FReg Ki 99 Flux Reg Kp 105 Trq Comp Regen 111
Slip Reg Enable 100 Trq Adapt Speed 106 Slip Adapt Iqs 112
Feedback & IO Feedback Pri Vel Fdbk Sel 125 Alt Vel Feedback 130 Mtr Psn Fdbk Sel 135 Delayed Spd Ref 139
Feedba Pri Vel FdbkFltr 126 Active Vel Fdbk 131 Load Psn FdbkSel 136 Virtual EncDelay 140
ck and
IO Pri Vel Feedback 127 Aux Vel Fdbk Sel 132 Open Loop Fdbk 137 Virtual Enc EPR 141
Alt Vel Fdbk Sel 128 Aux Vel FdbkFltr 133 Simulator Fdbk 138 Virtual Enc Psn 142
Alt Vel FdbkFltr 129 Aux Vel Feedback 134
Digin Functions Digital In Conf 150 DI Jog 1 166 DI Accel 2 179 DI PID Reset 193
DI Enable 155 DI Jog 1 Forward 167 DI Decel 2 180 DI PID Invert 194
DI Clear Fault 156 DI Jog 1 Reverse 168 DI SpTqPs Sel 0 181 DI Torque StptA 195
DI Aux Fault 157 DI Jog 2 169 DI SpTqPs Sel 1 182 DI Fwd End Limit 196
DI Stop 158 DI Jog 2 Forward 170 DI Stop Mode B 185 DI Fwd Dec Limit 197
DI Cur Lmt Stop 159 DI Jog 2 Reverse 171 DI BusReg Mode B 186 DI Rev End Limit 198
DI Coast Stop 160 DI Manual Ctrl 172 DI PwrLoss ModeB 187 DI Rev Dec Limit 199
DI Start 161 DI Speed Sel 0 173 DI Pwr Loss 188 DI PHdwr OvrTrvl 200
DI Fwd Reverse 162 DI Speed Sel 1 174 DI Precharge 189 DI NHdwr OvrTrvl 201
DI Run 163 DI Speed Sel 2 175 DI Prchrg Seal 190
DI Run Forward 164 DI MOP Inc 177 DI PID Enable 191
DI Run Reverse 165 DI MOP Dec 178 DI PID Hold 192
Control Board IO Digital In Sts 220
How Option Module Option module parameters are only available when that option is installed in
Parameters are Organized a host drive. To view and edit option module parameters, select the port
number of the device you want to access. See Select A Device on page D-5
for instructions.
I/O Modules
Parameter descriptions begin on page 3-120.
File Group Parameters
Host Groups Digital Inputs Dig In Sts 1 Dig In Filt Mask 2 Dig In Filt 3
Host G
roups Digital Outputs Dig Out Sts 5 RO0 Sel 10 RO1 Sel 20 TO1 Sel 30
Dig Out Invert 6 RO0 Level Sel 11 TO0 Sel 20 TO1 Level Sel 31
Dig Out Setpoint 7 RO0 Level 12 RO1 Level Sel 21 TO1 Level 32
RO0 Level CmpSts 13 RO1 Level 22 TO1 Level CmpSts 33
RO0 On Time 14 RO1 Level CmpSts 23 TO1 On Time 34
RO0 Off Time 15 RO1 On Time 24 TO1 Off Time 35
RO1 Off Time 25
Motor PTC PTC Cfg 40 PTC Sts 41 PTC Raw Value 42
Analog Inputs Anlg In Type 45 Anlg In0 Value 50 Anlg In1 Value 60
Anlg In Sqrt 46 Anlg In0 Hi 51 Anlg In1 Hi 61
Anlg In Loss Sts 47 Anlg In0 Lo 52 Anlg In1 Lo 62
Anlg In0 LssActn 53 Anlg In1 LssActn 63
Anlg In0 Raw Val 54 Anlg In1 Raw Val 64
Anlg In0 Filt Gn 55 Anlg In1 Filt Gn 65
Anlg In0 Filt BW 56 Anlg In1 Filt BW 66
Analog Outpts Anlg Out Type 70 Anlg Out0 Sel 75 Anlg Out1 Sel 85
Anlg Out Abs 71 Anlg Out0 Stpt 76 Anlg Out1 Stpt 86
Anlg Out0 Data 77 Anlg Out1 Data 87
Anlg Out0 DataHi 78 Anlg Out1 DataHi 88
Anlg Out0 DataLo 79 Anlg Out1 DataLo 89
Anlg Out0 Hi 80 Anlg Out1 Hi 90
Anlg Out0 Lo 81 Anlg Out1 Lo 91
Anlg Out0 Val 82 Anlg Out1 Val 92
Predictive Main PredMaint Sts 99 RO0 Load Type 100 RO1 Load Type 110
RO0 Load Amps 101 RO1 Load Amps 111
RO0 TotalLife 102 RO1 TotalLife 112
RO0 ElapsedLife 103 RO1 ElapsedLife 113
RO0 RemainLife 104 RO1 RemainLife 114
RO0 LifeEvntLvl 105 RO1 LifeEvntLvl 115
RO0 LifeEvntActn 106 RO1 LifeEvntActn 116
Embedded EtherNet/IP
Parameter descriptions begin on page 3-159.
File Group Parameters
Host Groups N/A DL From Net 01 1 Port Number 33 Flt Cfg DL 01 60 DLs Fr Peer Cfg 76
Host G
DL From Net 02 2 DLs From Net Act 34 Flt Cfg DL 02 61 DLs Fr Peer Act 77
roups
DL From Net 03 3 DLs To Net Act 35 Flt Cfg DL 03 62 Logic Src Cfg 78
DL From Net 04 4 BOOTP 36 Flt Cfg DL 04 63 Ref Src Cfg 79
DL From Net 05 5 Net Addr Src 37 Flt Cfg DL 05 64 Fr Peer Timeout 80
DL From Net 06 6 IP Addr Cfg 1 38 Flt Cfg DL 06 65 Fr Peer Addr 1 81
DL From Net 07 7 IP Addr Cfg 2 39 Flt Cfg DL 07 66 Fr Peer Addr 2 82
DL From Net 08 8 IP Addr Cfg 3 40 Flt Cfg DL 08 67 Fr Peer Addr 3 83
DL From Net 09 9 IP Addr Cfg 4 41 Flt Cfg DL 09 68 Fr Peer Addr 4 84
DL From Net 10 10 Subnet Cfg 1 42 Flt Cfg DL 10 69 Fr Peer Enable 85
DL From Net 11 11 Subnet Cfg 2 43 Flt Cfg DL 11 70 Fr Peer Status 86
DL From Net 12 12 Subnet Cfg 3 44 Flt Cfg DL 12 71 DLs To Peer Cfg 87
DL From Net 13 13 Subnet Cfg 4 45 Flt Cfg DL 13 72 DLs To Peer Act 88
DL From Net 14 14 Gateway Cfg 1 46 Flt Cfg DL 14 73 To Peer Period 89
DL From Net 15 15 Gateway Cfg 2 47 Flt Cfg DL 15 74 To Peer Skip 90
DL From Net 16 16 Gateway Cfg 3 48 Flt Cfg DL 16 75 To Peer Enable 91
DL To Net 01 17 Gateway Cfg 4 49
DL To Net 02 18 Net Rate Cfg 50
DL To Net 03 19 Net Rate Act 51
DL To Net 04 20 Web Enable 52
DL To Net 05 21 Web Features 53
DL To Net 06 22 Comm Flt Action 54
DL To Net 07 23 Idle Flt Action 55
DL To Net 08 24 Peer Flt Action 56
DL To Net 09 25 Msg Flt Action 57
DL To Net 10 26 Flt Cfg Logic 58
DL To Net 11 27 Flt Cfg Ref 59
DL To Net 12 28
DL To Net 13 29
DL To Net 14 30
DL To Net 15 31
DL To Net 16 32
Embedded DeviceLogix
Parameter descriptions begin on page G-2.
File Group Parameters
Host Groups Analog Outputs DLX Out 01 1 DLX Out 05 5 DLX Out 09 9 DLX Out 13 13
Host G
DLX Out 02 2 DLX Out 06 6 DLX Out 10 10 DLX Out 14 14
roups
DLX Out 03 3 DLX Out 07 7 DLX Out 11 11 DLX Out 15 15
DLX Out 04 4 DLX Out 08 8 DLX Out 12 12 DLX Out 16 16
Analog Inputs DLX In 01 17 DLX In 05 21 DLX In 09 25 DLX In 13 29
DLX In 02 18 DLX In 06 22 DLX In 10 26 DLX In 14 30
DLX In 03 19 DLX In 07 23 DLX In 11 27 DLX In 15 31
DLX In 04 20 DLX In 08 24 DLX In 12 28 DLX In 16 32
Digital Inputs DLX DIP 01 33 DLX DIP 05 37 DLX DIP 09 41 DLX DIP 13 45
DLX DIP 02 34 DLX DIP 06 38 DLX DIP 10 42 DLX DIP 14 46
DLX DIP 03 35 DLX DIP 07 39 DLX DIP 11 43 DLX DIP 15 47
DLX DIP 04 36 DLX DIP 08 40 DLX DIP 12 44 DLX DIP 16 48
Status & Cntl DLX DigIn Sts 49 DLX DigOut Sts 50 DLX Prog Cond 52 DLX Operation 53
DLX DigOut Sts2 51
Internal Regs DLX Real SP1 54 DLX DDINT SP1 70 DLX Bool SP1 78
DLX Real SP2 55 DLX DDINT SP2 71 DLX Bool SP2 79
DLX Real SP3 56 DLX DDINT SP3 72 DLX Bool SP3 80
DLX Real SP4 57 DLX DDINT SP4 73 DLX Bool SP4 81
DLX Real SP5 58 DLX DDINT SP5 74
DLX Real SP6 59 DLX DDINT SP6 75
DLX Real SP7 60 DLX DDINT SP7 76
DLX Real SP8 61 DLX DDINT SP8 77
DLX Real SP9 62
DLX Real SP10 63
DLX Real SP11 64
DLX Real SP12 65
DLX Real SP13 66
DLX Real SP14 67
DLX Real SP15 68
DLX Real SP16 69
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
The total output current present at terminals T1, T2, and T3 (U, V & W). Min/Max: 0.00 / P21 [Rated Amps] x 2
8 Output Voltage Units: VAC RO Real
Output Voltage Default: Based on Drive Rating
Output voltage present at terminals T1, T2, and T3 (U, V & W). Min/Max: 0.00 / P20 [Rated Volts] x 1.15
9 Output Power Units: kW RO Real
Output Power Default: 0.00
Output power present at terminals T1, T2, and T3 (U, V & W). Min/Max: 0.00/100.00
10 Output Powr Fctr Default: 0.00 RO Real
Output Power Factor Min/Max: 0.00/1.00
Output power factor.
11 DC Bus Volts Units: VDC RO Real
Direct Current Bus Volts Default: Based on Drive Rating
DC bus voltage. Min/Max: 0.00 / P20 [Rated Volts] x 2
12 DC Bus Memory Units: VDC RO Real
Direct Current Bus Memory Default: Based on Drive Rating
A six minute average of P11 [DC Bus Volts] used to estimate the DC equivalent of Min/Max: 0.00 / P20 [Rated Volts] x 2
the input voltage. Automatically initialized upon power-up, continually updated
during normal operation, and is used to trigger a power loss condition.
13 Elapsed MWH Units: MWh RO Real
Elapsed Megawatt Hour Default: 0.000
Accumulated output energy of the drive. Min/Max: 0.000 / 4294967295.000
14 Elapsed kWH Units: kWh RO Real
Elapsed Kilowatt Hour Default: 0.000
Accumulated output energy of the drive. Min/Max: 0.000 / 4294967295.000
15 Elapsed Run Time Units: Hrs RO Real
Elapsed Run Time Default: 0.000
Accumulated time drive is outputting power. Min/Max: 0.000 / 220000000.000
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
Data Type
Group
Name
File
2 = “Induct Econ”
3 = “Induction FV”
4 = “PM VHz”
5 = “PM SV”
6 = “PM FV”
7 = “SyncRel VHz”
8 = “SyncRel SV”
Read-Write
Data Type
Group Name
File
Options
PWM FreqLock
Trq ModeStop
Mtr Lead Rev
EnclsTrqProv
Reflect Wave
Trq ModeJog
Zero TrqStop
RS Adaption
Xsistor Diag
Jerk Select
Elect Stab
Reserved
Id Comp
The maximum allowed bus voltage utilization for the Motor Control. Do not Min/Max: 85.00 / 100.00
Mtr Ctrl Options
change this value without consulting Technical Support. Higher values may result
in control instability or over-current faults.
43 Flux Up Enable Default: 1 = “Automatic” RW Real
Flux Up Enable Options: 0 = “Manual”
“Manual” (0) – Flux is established for P44 [Flux Up Time] before acceleration. 1 = “Automatic”
“Automatic” (1) – Flux is established for a calculated time period based on motor
nameplate data before acceleration. P44 [Flux Up Time] is not used.
44 Flux Up Time Units: Secs RW Real
Flux Up Time Default: 0.0000
The amount of time the drive will use to try to achieve full motor stator flux. When Min/Max: 0.0000 / 5.0000
a Start command is issued, DC current at P26 [Motor NP Amps] level is used to
build stator flux before accelerating.
45 Flux Down Ki Default: 0.20 RW Real
Flux Down Ki Min/Max: 0.00 / 100.00
The integral term used in the voltage regulator which controls the removal of flux
in the motor.
46 Flux Down Kp Default: 150.0 RW Real
Flux Down Kp Min/Max: 0.0 / 10000.0
The proportional term used in the voltage regulator which controls the removal of
flux in the motor.
47 Econ At Ref Ki Default: 305.0 RW Real
Economize At Reference Ki Min/Max: 0.0 / 100000.0
Integral gain that determines the response of the output voltage when P35 [Motor
Ctrl Mode] option 2 “Induct Econ” is selected and the output frequency is at its
reference.
48 Econ AccDec Ki Default: 200.0 RW Real
Economize Acceleration/Deceleration Ki Min/Max: 0.0 / 100000.0
Integral gain that determines the response of the output voltage when P35 [Motor
Ctrl Mode] option 2 “Induct Econ” is selected and the output frequency is either
accelerating or decelerating to a reference.
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
The voltage the drive will output at P63 [Break Frequency] when a “VHz” mode is Min/Max: 0.00 / P25 [Motor NP Volts] x 1.5
Volts per Hertz
selected, according to P35 [Motor Ctrl Mode]. Refer to diagram for P524
[Overspeed Limit].
63 Break Frequency Units: Hz RW Real
Break Frequency Default: P27 [Motor NP Hertz] x 0.25
The frequency the drive will output at P62 [Break Voltage] when a “VHz” mode is Min/Max: 0.00 / P27 [Motor NP Hertz]
selected, according to P35 [Motor Ctrl Mode]. Refer to diagram for P524
[Overspeed Limit].
64 SVC Boost Filter Units: Secs RW Real
SVC Boost Filter Default: 0.1000
The voltage boost filter time constant when a “VHz” mode is selected, according Min/Max: 0.0001 / 1000.0000
to P35 [Motor Ctrl Mode].
65 VHz Curve Default: 0 = “Custom V/Hz” RW 32-bit
VHz Curve Options: 0 = “Custom V/Hz” Integer
Selects either a predefined curve (e.g. Fan/Pump), or a custom curve when a 1 = “Fan/Pump”
“VHz” mode is selected, according to P35 [Motor Cntl Mode]. Refer to diagram for
P524 [Overspeed Limit].
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
AutoOfstTest
Options
Vqs Reg En
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Default 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
0 = Condition False
Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 1 = Condition True
The amount of offset between the primary feedback encoder counts, and the
rotor flux center position of the PM motor. A value of 1024 is equal to 360
Autotune
electrical degrees. This parameter is updated during the PM Offset test which
runs at the first start after a power cycle/ system reset (P80 [PM Cfg] Bit 0 = 1)
and during autotune in PM FV mode.
82 PM AltEnc Offset Default: 0 RW 32-bit
Permanent Magnet Motor Alternate Encoder Offset Min/Max: 0 / 1023 Integer
The amount of offset between the alternate feedback encoder counts, and the
rotor flux center position of the PM motor. A value of 1024 is equal to 360
electrical degrees. This parameter is updated during the PM Offset test which
runs at the first start after a power cycle/ system reset (P80 [PM Cfg] Bit 0 = 1)
and during autotune in PM FV mode. Active only when Alternate Velocity
Feedback is being used during Auto Tach Loss Switchover (see P635 [Spd
Options Ctrl]).
83 PM OfstTst Cur Units: % RW Real
Permanent Magnet Motor Offset Test Current Default: 40.00
Amplitude of the current command in per unit of the motor rated current during Min/Max: 0.00 / 200.00
the PM Offset Test, which is one of the auto tune tests in PM FV mode.
84 PM OfstTst CRamp Units: Secs RW Real
Permanent Magnet Motor Offset Test Current Ramp Default: 3.00
Ramp time of the current command during the PM Offset Test in PM FV mode, Min/Max: 0.00 / 100.00
which is defined as ramp time to reach the P80 [PM Cfg] current command
amplitude.
85 PM OfstTst FRamp Units: Secs RW Real
Permanent Magnet Motor Offset Test Frequency Ramp Default: 60.00
Defines the frequency ramp time of the current command during the PM Offset Min/Max: 0.00 / 1000.00
Test in PM FV mode, which is defined as ramp time in seconds from 0 to 3 Hz.
86 PM CEMF Voltage Units: VAC RW Real
Permanent Magnet Motor Counter Electro Motive Force Default: P25 [Motor NP Volts] x 0.0675
Counter electromotive force (CEMF) voltage displayed in line-to-line rms value, Min/Max: 0.00 / P25 [Motor NP Volts] x 1.5
which is normalized to the base motor speed. Updated after the completion of the
auto tune in PM FV mode.
Read-Write
Data Type
Group Name
File
Voltage across the d-axis stator inductance of the PM motor at the rated motor Min/Max: 0.00 / P25 [Motor NP Volts] x 1.5
Autotune
current and the rated motor frequency displayed in line-to-line rms value.
Updated after the completion of the auto tune in PM FV mode.
91 PM Vqs Reg Kp Default: 2.50 RW Real
Permanent Magnet Motor Vqs Regulator Proportional Gain Min/Max: 0.00 / 1000.00
Proportional gain of the vqs regulator in PM FV mode. When P80 [PM Cfg] Bit 1
= 1, the vqs regulator will be active either when the motor voltage exceeds the
voltage limited by the DC bus voltage or when the motor voltage exceeds the
value set by P36 [Maximum Voltage].
92 PM Vqs Reg Ki Default: 0.50 RW Real
Permanent Magnet Motor Vqs Regulator Integral Gain Min/Max: 0.00 / 1000.00
Integral gain of the vqs regulator in PM FV mode.
93 PM Dir Test Cur Units: Amps RW Real
Permanent Magnet Motor Direction Test Current Default: P26 [Motor NP Amps]/10
Amount of current commanded during the direction test when P35 [Motor Ctrl Min/Max: 0.00 / P26 [Motor NP Amps]
Mode] option 6 “PM FV” is selected. When the Start-Up feature is used, this value
is automatically set to 10% of the motor rated current.
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
Read-Write
Data Type
Group Name
File
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
The Disabled and Open Loop Fdbk selections are functionally equivalent, with
Feedback
Open Loop being the default setting. Open Loop velocity feedback is estimated
based on P1 [Output Frequency] and P5 [Torque Cur Fdbk], adjusted using P621
[Slip RPM @ FLA].
Simulator Fdbk is available in the Flux Vector selections for P35 [Motor Ctrl
Mode]. Simulator velocity feedback is calculated based on P690 [Limited Trq Ref]
and P76 [Total Inertia]. This selection is useful for drive operational checkout and
test when motor movement is undesired. In simulation mode, gating of the power
inverter section of the drive is disabled.
Selection of any option module port that contains an encoder module results in
P3 [Mtr Vel Fdbk] based on a measured value. Data obtained from the selected
feedback module will be used to determine motor velocity feedback.
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
Selects the source of the P3 [Mtr Vel Fdbk] and P131 [Active Vel Fdbk] to be used
when the drive is in operation with an auto Tach Loss Switchover.
Feedback
Read-Write
Data Type
Group Name
File
value forms the primary feedback for the position regulator integration channel.
Feedback
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
ATTENTION: Equipment damage and/or personal injury may result if this parameter is used in an
inappropriate application. Do not use this function without considering applicable local, national and
! international codes, standards, regulations, or industry guidelines.
FEEDBACK & IO
Digin Functions
Read-Write
Data Type
Group Name
File
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
Min/Max: 0 / 159999.15
Assigns a digital input used to activate P536 [Accel Time 2].
180 DI Decel 2 Default: 0 RW 32-bit
Digital Input Deceleration 2 Min/Max: 0 / 159999.15 Integer
Assigns a digital input used to activate P538 [Decel Time 2].
181 DI SpTqPs Sel 0 Default: 0 RW 32-bit
182 DI SpTqPs Sel 1 Min/Max: 0 / 159999.15 Integer
Digital Input Speed Torque Position Select 0, 1
Assigns digital inputs used to select between speed, torque, and position modes.
185 DI Stop Mode B Default: 0 RW 32-bit
Digital Input Stop Mode B Min/Max: 0 / 159999.15 Integer
Assigns a digital input used to activate P371 [Stop Mode B].
186 DI BusReg Mode B Default: 0 RW 32-bit
Digital Input Bus Regulation Mode B Min/Max: 0 / 159999.15 Integer
Assigns a digital input used to activate P373 [Bus Reg Mode B].
187 DI PwrLoss ModeB Default: 0 RW 32-bit
Digital Input Power Loss Mode B Min/Max: 0 / 159999.15 Integer
Assigns a digital input used to activate P453 [Pwr Loss Mode B].
188 DI Pwr Loss Default: 0 RW 32-bit
Digital Input Power Loss Min/Max: 0 / 159999.15 Integer
Assigns a digital input used to force a power loss condition.
189 DI Precharge Default: 0 RW 32-bit
Digital Input Precharge Min/Max: 0 / 159999.15 Integer
Assigns a digital input used to force the drive into precharge (normally only used
in common bus applications).
190 DI Prchrg Seal Default: 0 RW 32-bit
Digital Input Precharge Seal Min/Max: 0 / 159999.15 Integer
Assigns a digital input used to force a unique fault when an external precharge
circuit opens.
Read-Write
Data Type
Group Name
File
Data Type
Group
Name
File
Status of the digital input(s) resident on the main control board (Port 0).
Digital In 0
Options
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
normally recommended (makes the list very long), and shows extra parameters
DRIVE CFG
that should rarely be required. When the access level is changed, PC based tools
(e.g. Drive Tools and Drive Explorer) will require a reconnect.
This parameter is only reset when Set Defaults “All” (not recommended) is
executed.
302 Language Default: 0 = “Not Used” RW 32-bit
Language Options: 0 = “Not Used” Integer
Select display language. 1 = “English”
This parameter is only reset when Set Defaults “All” (not recommended) is 2 = “Spanish”
executed. 3 = “French”
4 = “Italian”
5 = “German”
6 = “Dutch”
7 = “Portuguese”
8 = “Chinese”
9 = “Japanese”
10 = “Korean”
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
This parameter is only reset when Set Defaults “All” (not recommended) is
executed.
308 Direction Mode Default: 0 = “Unipolar” RW 32-bit
Direction Mode Options: 0 = “Unipolar” Integer
Selects method for changing direction. 1 = “Bipolar”
Mode Direction Change 2 = “Rev Disable”
Unipolar Drive Logic
Bipolar Sign of Reference
Rev Disable Not Changeable
ATTENTION: Enabling the Bipolar Direction Mode can cause unexpected direction changes. Equipment
damage and/or personal injury can result if this parameter is used in an inappropriate application. Do Not use
! this function without considering all applicable local, national, and international codes standards, regulations,
or industry guidelines.
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
“SLAT Min” (3) – Drive operates in “Speed Limited Adjustable Torque – Minimum
select” mode. This is a special mode of operation used primarily in winder
applications. The drive will typically operate as a torque regulator, provided that
the P4 [Commanded Trq] value is algebraically smaller in value than the speed
regulator’s output. The drive may automatically enter speed regulation mode,
based on conditions within the speed regulator and the magnitude of the speed
regulator’s output relative to the torque reference.
“SLAT Max” (4) – Drive operates in “Speed Limited Adjustable Torque –
Maximum select” mode. This is a special mode of operation used primarily in
winder applications. The drive will typically operate as a torque regulator,
provided that the P4 [Commanded Trq] value is algebraically larger in value than
the speed regulator’s output. The drive may automatically enter speed regulation
mode, based on conditions within the speed regulator and the magnitude of the
speed regulator’s output relative to the torque reference.
“Sum” (5) – Drive operates as a speed regulator. P685 [Selected Trq Ref] comes
from P660 [SReg Output] plus torque adders summed with P4 [Commanded Trq].
“Profilier” (6) – Drive uses the Speed Profiler / Position Indexer function. The drive
operates as either a speed or position regulator. Mode of operation will depend
on the configuration of the Step Types in the Profiler / Indexer table.
“Psn P2P” (7) – Drive operates as a position regulator. P685 [Selected Trq Ref]
has the same source as in Sum mode. The position control is active in
Point-to-Point mode and uses its Point-to-point position reference.
“Psn Camming” (8) – Drive operates as a position regulator. P685 [Selected Trq
Ref] has the same source as in Sum mode. The position control is active in
Position CAM mode and uses its PCAM Planner position and speed reference.
“Psn PLL” (9) – Drive operates as a position regulator. P685 [Selected Trq Ref]
has the same source as in Sum mode. The position control is active in Position
Phase Lock Loop mode and uses its PLL Planner position and speed reference.
“Psn Direct” (10) – Drive operates as a position regulator. P685 [Selected Trq
Ref] has the same source as in Sum mode. The position control is active in Direct
mode and uses its Direct Position Reference.
Read-Write
Data Type
Group Name
File
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Options
Digital In
Port 14
Port 13
Port 6
Port 5
Port 4
Port 3
Port 2
Port 1
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Options
Digital In
Port 14
Port 13
Port 6
Port 5
Port 4
Port 3
Port 2
Port 1
Default 0 1 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 0 = Condition False
Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 1 = Condition True
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Options
Digital In
Port 14
Port 13
Port 6
Port 5
Port 4
Port 3
Port 2
Port 1
Default 0 1 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 0 = Condition False
Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 1 = Condition True
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Options
Digital In
Port 14
Port 13
DRIVE CFG
Port 6
Port 5
Port 4
Port 3
Port 2
Port 1
Reserved
Options
Port 3
Port 2
Port 1
Read-Write
Data Type
Drive Memory Group
Name
DRIVE CFG File
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
ATTENTION: Equipment damage and/or personal injury may result if this parameter is used in an
inappropriate application. Do not use this function without considering applicable local, national and
! international codes, standards, regulations or industry guidelines.
AttmpsExhstd
Options
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
ATTENTION: Equipment damage and/or personal injury may result if this parameter is used in an
inappropriate application. Do not use this function without considering applicable local, national and
! international codes, standards, regulations or industry guidelines.
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
ATTENTION: Enabling the Sleep/Wake function can cause unexpected machine operation during the Wake
mode. Equipment damage and/or personal injury can result if this parameter is used in an inappropriate
! application. Do Not use this function without considering the information below. In addition, all applicable
local, national, and international codes, standards, regulations, or industry guidelines must be considered.
(4)
New Start or Run Cmd. Analog Sig. > Sleep Level (6)
Invert Mode
Analog Sig. < Sleep Level (6)
New Start or Run Cmd.(4)
Run Run Closed New Run Cmd.(5) Run Closed New Run Cmd.(5)
Run For. Wake Signal Wake Signal Wake Signal Wake Signal
Run Rev.
(1)
When power is cycled, if all of the above conditions are present after power is restored, restart will occur.
(2)
If all of the above conditions are present when [Sleep-Wake Mode] is “enabled,” the drive will start.
(3)
The active speed reference. The Sleep/Wake function and the speed reference may be assigned to the same input.
(4)
Command must be issued from HIM, TB, or network.
(5)
Run Command must be cycled.
(6)
Signal does not need to be greater than wake level.
(7)
For Invert function, refer to [Analog In x Loss].
351 SleepWake RefSel Default: 0 (Disabled) RW 32-bit
Sleep Wake Reference Select Min/Max: 0 / 159999 Integer
Selects the source of the input controlling the Sleep-Wake function.
352 Sleep Level Units: VAC, P351 = 0 (Disabled) RW Real
Sleep Level VAC or mA, P351 = not 0 (Port X Device
Jumper Setting)
Defines the analog input level that will stop the drive.
Default: 5.00 VAC (P351 = 0)
5.00 VAC / 0.00 mA (Port X Device
Jumper Setting)
Min/Max: 0.00 / 10.00 VAC
0.00 / 20.00 mA
353 Sleep Time Units: Secs RW Real
Sleep Time Default: 0.00
Defines the amount of time at or below 352 [Sleep Level] before a Stop is issued. Min/Max: 0.00 / 1000.00
Read-Write
Data Type
Group Name
File
Integral term used in the current regulator which controls the reconnect function.
359 FS Speed Reg Ki Default: 100.0 RW Real
Flying Start Speed Regulator Intergal Gain Min/Max: 0.0 / 10000.0
Integral term used in the speed regulator which controls the reconnect function.
360 FS Speed Reg Kp Default: 75.0 RW Real
Flying Start Speed Regulator Proportional Gain Min/Max: 0.0 / 100000.0
Proportional term used in the speed regulator which controls the reconnect
function.
361 FS Excitation Ki Default: 60.0 RW Real
Flying Start Excitation Intergal Gain Min/Max: 0.0 / 32767.0
Integral term used in the current regulator which controls the excitation function
when the need is determined by the reconnect function.
362 FS Excitation Kp Default: 1200.00 RW Real
Flying Start Excitation Proportional Gain Min/Max: 0.0 / 32767.0
Proportional term used in the current regulator which controls the excitation
function when the need is determined by the reconnect function.
363 FS Reconnect Dly Units: Secs RW Real
Flying Start Reconnect Delay Default: 50.00
Delay time used between the issued start command and the start of the Min/Max: 0.10 / 10000.00
reconnect function.
364 FS Msrmnt CurLvl Default: 44.97 RW Real
Flying Start Measurement Current Level Min/Max: 0.00 / 4096.00
Level of the current used during the measurement stage of the reconnect
function.
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
ATTENTION: The drive does not offer protection for externally-mounted brake resistors. A risk of fire
exists if external braking resistors are not protected. External resistor packages must be self-protected from
! over-temperature or the protective circuit shown in Figure C.1 on page C-2 (or equivalent) must be supplied.
Read-Write
Data Type
Group Name
File
ATTENTION: Equipment damage may result if a drive mounted (internal) resistor is installed and this
parameter is set to “External.” Thermal protection for the internal resistor will be disabled, resulting in
!
Braking Features
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
Read-Write
Data Type
Group Name
File
ShutOff is selected, this parameter sets the level sensitivity for shut off.
403 Brake Off Adj 2 Default: 1.00 RW Real
Brake Off Adjustment 2 Min/Max: 0.01 / 5.00
When Fast Braking is the selected Stop Mode, this parameter sets the frequency
sensitivity to transition from Fast Braking to DC Brake. When DC Brake w/Auto
ShutOff is selected, this parameter sets the time sensitivity for shut off.
409 Dec Inhibit Actn Default: 3 = “FltCoastStop” RW 32-bit
Deceleration Inhibit Action Options: 0 = “Ignore” Integer
Configures the response to a Decel Inhibit condition, which occurs when the drive 1 = “Alarm”
is not decelerating due to bus voltage regulation. 2 = “Flt Minor”
3 = “FltCoastStop”
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
Default: 0.00
Sets the level of P418 [Mtr OL Counts] for which a motor overload alarm will Min/Max: 0.00 / 100.00
occur. Useful to provide warning prior to the drive taking action that is selected by
P410 [Motor OL Actn]. This alarm level is different than , and independent of, the
“Alarm” action selected by P410 [Motor OL Actn].
413 Mtr OL Factor Default: 1.00 RW Real
Motor Overload Factor Min/Max: 0.20 / 2.00
Sets the minimum level of current (in percent or P26 [Motor NP Amps]) that
causes the motor overload counter to increment. Current levels below this value
will decrement the overload counter. For example, a service factor of 1.15 implies
continuous operation up to 115% of nameplate motor current.
414 Mtr OL Hertz Units: Hz RW Real
Motor Overload Hertz Default: 20.00
Selects the output frequency below which the motor operating current is derated Min/Max: 0.00 / 4096
(more sensitive) to account for the reduced self-cooling capability of typical
motors, operating at slower speeds. For motors with extra low speed cooling
capacity (e.g. 10:1 or blower cooled), reduce this setting to take full advantage of
the motor being used.
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
occurred and the value in P418 [Mtr OL Counts] is less than the P415 [Mtr OL
Reset Lvl].
418 Mtr OL Counts Units: % RW Real
Motor Overload Counts Default: 0.00
Accumulated percentage of motor overload. Continuously operating the motor Min/Max: 0.0 / 100.00
over 100% of the motor overload setting will increase this value to 100% and
cause the action selected in P410 [Motor OL Actn] to be taken.
419 Mtr OL Trip Time Units: Secs RW 32-bit
Motor Overload Trip time Default: 99999 Integer
Displays the inverse of the motor overload time, equal to the number of seconds Min/Max: 0 / 99999
before P418 [Mtr OL Counts] reaches 100%, and the motor overload action is
taken.
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
Read-Write
Data Type
Group Name
File
Options
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
Loss Action]).
444 OutPhaseLossActn Default: 0 = “Ignore” RW 32-bit
Output Phase Loss Action Options: 0 = “Ignore” Integer
Selects action to take if output phase loss is detected. 1 = “Alarm”
2 = “Flt Continue”
3 = “FltCoastStop”
4 = “Flt RampStop”
5 = “Flt CL Stop”
445 Out PhaseLossLvl Default: 200 RW 32-bit
Output Phase Loss Level Min/Max: 0 / 1000 Integer
Sets the threshold level which is used to determine an output phase loss
condition.
449 Power Loss Actn Default: 1 = “Alarm” RW 32-bit
Power Loss Action Options: 0 = “Ignore” Integer
Configures the drive’s response to a power loss timeout condition. 1 = “Alarm”
2 = “Flt Continue”
3 = “FltCoastStop”
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
Sets the bus voltage level at which ride-through begins and modulation ends.
When bus voltage falls below this level, the drive prepares for an automatic
restart. Enter a percentage of the bus voltage derived from the high voltage
setting for the voltage class.
For example: on a 400/480V drive,
Read-Write
Data Type
Group Name
File
2 = “Flt Continue”
3 = “FltCoastStop”
4 = “Flt RampStop”
5 = “Flt CL Stop”
461 UnderVltg Level Units: VDC RW Real
Under Voltage Level Default: P20 [Rated Volts] x 0.3913
AC line voltage level below which an undervoltage event occurs. Min/Max: 0.00 / P20 [Rated Volts] x 1.41
462 InPhase LossActn Default: 3 = “FltCoastStop” RW 32-bit
In Phase Loss Action Options: 0 = “Ignore” Integer
Selects action to take if an Input Phase loss is detected. 1 = “Alarm”
2 = “Flt Continue”
3 = “FltCoastStop”
4 = “Flt RampStop”
5 = “Flt CL Stop”
463 InPhase Loss Lvl Default: 325 RW 32-bit
In Phase Loss Level Min/Max: 10 / 32767 Integer
Sets the threshold level which is used to determine an Input phase loss condition.
464 DC Bus Mem Reset Default: 0 = “Disabled” RW 32-bit
Direct Current Bus Memory Reset Options: 0 = “Disabled” Integer
Forces a manual update to P12 [DC Bus Memory], which is automatically 1 = “Enabled”
initialized upon power-up and continually updated during normal operation. A
manual reset is rarely required, but may occur when when input voltage is
abnormally high or low for an extended period of time followed by a fast return to
a nominal value. A transition from 0 to 1 will cause an update, only if the drive is
not regenerating and not firing the dynamic brake. The update will be ignored of
not completed with 30 seconds of the command.
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
2 = “Flt Continue”
3 = “FltCoastStop”
4 = “Flt RampStop”
5 = “Flt CL Stop”
467 Ground Warn Lvl Units: Amps RW
Ground Warning Level Default: 3.0
Sets the level at which a ground warning alarm will occur. Min/Max: 1.0 / 5.0
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
Options
Internal Fan
Mtr Bearing
Mch Lube
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Mtr Lube
Master
Default 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 = False
1 = True
Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Read-Write
Data Type
Group Name
File
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
Accumulated hours since the most recent lubrication of the motor bearings. Can Min/Max: 0.00 / 21,474,836.47
be reset without restriction.
509 MtrLubeEventLvl Units: Hrs RW Real
Motor Lubricant Event Level Default: 0.000
Number of hours between scheduled lubrications of the motor bearings. Used for Min/Max: 0.000 / 220000000.000
an early warning alarm or fault according to P510 [MtrLubeEventActn]. Event is
disabled when set to 0.
510 MtrLubeEventActn Default: 0 = “Ignore” RW 32-bit
Motor Lubricant Event Action Options: 0 = “Ignore” Integer
Configures the response to a motor bearing lubrication event, which occurs when 1 = “Alarm”
P510 [MtrLubeEventLvl] is met or exceeded. 2 = “Flt Continue”
3 = “FltCoastStop”
4 = “Flt RampStop”
5 = “Flt CL Stop”
511 MchBrngTotalLife Units: Hrs RW 32-bit
Machine Bearing Total Life Default: Current Value Integer
Total number of hours expected over the life of the machine bearings. Min/Max: 0 / 21,474,836.47
512 MchBrngElpsdLife Units: Hours RW 32-bit
Machine Bearing Elapsed Life Default: 0.00 Integer
Accumulated hours of machine bearing run time. Min/Max: 0 / 21,474,836.47
513 MchBrngRemainLif Units: Hrs RW 32-bit
Machine Bearing Remaining Life Default: 0.00 Integer
Remaining number of hours until estimated end of life for machine bearings, and Min/Max: –21,474,836.48 / 21,474,836.47
is the difference between Machine Bearing Total Life and Machine Bearing
Elapsed Life.
514 MchBrngEventLvl Units: % RW Real
Machine Bearing Event Level Default: 80.000
Percent of total expected machine bearing life for which an early warning alarm or Min/Max: 0.000 / 100.000
fault can be programmed.
Read-Write
Data Type
Group Name
File
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
Sets the reverse speed low limit. Refer to P524 [Overspeed Limit]. When using an Default: P27 [Motor NP Hertz] x –1.00
analog input for the speed reference, this parameter is scaled to [Anlg In X Hi]. P28 [Motor NP RPM] x –1.00
Min/Max: [Motor NP Hertz] x –16.00 / 0.00
[Motor NP RPM] x –16.00 / 0.00
522 Min Fwd Speed Units: Hz RW Real
Minimum Forward Speed RPM
Sets the low limit for speed reference after scaling is applied. Refer to P524 Default: 0.00
[Overspeed Limit]. Min/Max: 0.00 / [Motor NP Hertz] x 16.00
0.00 / [Motor NP RPM] x 16.00
523 Min Rev Speed Units: Hz RW Real
Minimum Reverse Speed RPM
Sets the low limit for speed reference after scaling is applied. Refer to P524 Default: 0.00
[Overspeed Limit]. Min/Max: [Motor NP Hertz] x –16.00 / 0.00
[Motor NP RPM] x –16.00 / 0.00
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
Motor Volts
Frequency Trim due to Overspeed
Speed Control Mode Limit
Break Volts
Start Boost
SPEED CONTROL
Speed Limits
Run
0 Min Break Motor Max Output Max
Speed Frequency Hz Speed Freq Limit Freq
Frequency
525 Zero Speed Limit Units: Hz RW Real
Zero Speed Limit RPM
Establishes a band around zero speed that is used to determine when the drive Default: P27 [Motor NP Hertz] x 0.001
considers the motor to be at zero speed. P28 [Motor NP RPM] x 0.001
Min/Max: 0.00 / P27 [Motor NP Hertz] x 0.5
0.00 / P28 [Motor NP RPM] x 0.5
526 Skip Speed 1 Units: Hz RW Real
527 Skip Speed 2 Default: 0.00
528 Skip Speed 3 Min/Max: P521 [Max Rev Speed] / P520 [Max Fwd
Skip Speed 1, 2, 3
Speed]
Sets a frequency at which the drive will not operate. [Skip Speed X] and P529
[Skip Speed Band] must not equal 0.
529 Skip Speed Band Units: Hz RW Real
Skip Speed Band RPM
Sets the bandwidth around a skip speed. [Skip Speed Band] is split, applying 1/2 Default: 0.00
above and 1/2 below the skip speed. The same bandwidth applies to all skip Min/Max: 0.00 / P27 [Motor NP Hertz] x 0.5
speeds. 0.00 / P28 [Motor NP RPM] x 0.5
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
70.0
60.0
Speed Ramp Rates
SPEED CONTROL
50.0
40.0
Hz
30.0
20.0
10.0
0.0
0.0 1.0 2.0 3.0 4.0 5.0 6.0
Seconds
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
At Stop
Default 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 = False
1 = True
Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
Decel Lmt Sw
MicroPsnMult
Options
Unipolar Ref
Sel Override
Rev Disable
Preset Auto
Bipolar Ref
Ref B Auto
Ref A Auto
Ref B Mult
Ref A Mult
Skip Band
Reserved
Trim Ref
Default 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 = False
1 = True
Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Displays the operating status of the speed referencing section of the drive. Individual bits are provided to represent the following conditions:
Bit 0 “Ref A Auto” – When set, the Reference A Auto path is active.
Control Logic has selected the Speed Reference source A. The exact origin of this speed reference is determined by the parameter specified in P545
[Spd Ref A Sel]. This parameter should also be reported in P930 [Speed Ref Source].
Bit 1 “Ref B Auto” – When set, the Reference B Auto path is active.
Control Logic has selected the Speed Reference source B. The exact origin of this speed reference is determined by the value specified in P550 [Spd
Ref B Sel]. This parameter should also be reported in P930 [Speed Ref Source].
Bit 2 “Ref A Mult” – When set, speed reference A is being modified by P549 [Spd Ref A Mult]. When clear, either the multiplier is 1 or is not affecting
the speed reference because the Ref A Auto path is inactive.
Bit 3 “Ref B Mult” – When set, the speed reference B is being modified by P554 [Spd Ref B Mult]. When clear, either the multiplier is 1 or is not
affecting the speed reference because the “Ref B Auto” path is inactive.
Bit 4 “MicroPsnMult” – When set, P592 [Selected Spd Ref] is being multiplied by P1112 [MicroPsnScalePct].
SPEED CONTROL
Speed Reference
Bit 5 “Trim Pct Ref” – When set, the speed reference is being multiplied by one plus the value of the parameter indicated in P616 [SpdTrimPrcRefSrc].
Bit 6 “Trim Ref” – When set, the speed reference is being offset by the value of the parameter indicated in P617 [Spd Trim Source].
Bit 7 “Preset Auto” – When set, Control Logic has selected a preset auto speed reference. The P930 [Speed Ref Source] parameter will indicate the
source of this reference.
Bit 8 “Sel Override” – The Selected Speed Reference parameter has been overridden by another reference. Refer to P930 [Speed Ref Source] for the
cause of the override.
Bit 9 “Bipolar Ref” – When set, P308 [Direction Mode] = 1 “Bipolar.” When in bipolar mode, the sign of the speed reference value will determine the
direction of motor rotation.
Bit 10 “Rev Disable” – When set, P308 [Direction Mode] = 2 “Rev Disable.” When in reverse disable mode, negative speed reference values are
rejected and a zero speed value is used in their place.
Bit 11 “Unipolar Ref” – When set, P308 [Direction Mode] = 0 “Unipolar.” When in unipolar mode, the sign of the speed reference value (and therefore
direction of motor rotation) is determined by P879 [Drive Logic Rslt] Bit 4 “Forward” and Bit 5 “Reverse.”
Bit 12 “Decel Lmt Sw” – When set, the Torque Proving function's control logic has detected a decel limit switch active and has selected P571 [Preset
Speed 1] for the speed reference value.
Bit 13 “End Lim Sw” – When set, the Torque Proving function's control logic has detected an end limit switch active and has selected zero speed for
the speed reference value.
Bit 14 “Skip Band” – When set, the Skip Band function has modified P2 [Commanded SpdRef]. When clear, the Skip Band function has not changed
p2 [Commanded SpdRef].
592 Selected Spd Ref Units: Hz RW Real
Selected Speed Reference RPM
Displays the value of the active speed reference. Default: 0.00
Min/Max: –/+P27 [Motor NP Hertz]
–/+P28 [Motor NP RPM]
593 Limited Spd Ref Units: Hz RW Real
Limited Speed Reference Default: RPM
Displays the value of the speed reference after the following limits have been Min/Max: 0.00
applied: P520 [Max Fwd Speed], P521 [Max Rev Speed], P522 [Min Fwd Speed] –/+P27 [Motor NP Hertz]
and P523 [Min Rev Speed]. –/+P28 [Motor NP RPM]
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
0.00
Speed Reference
This parameter is shared by both the Inertia Compensation and Speed Min/Max:
Compensation functions. These functions are only available in the Flux Vector –/+P27 [Motor NP Hertz]
selections for P35 [Motor Ctrl Mode]. –/+P28 [Motor NP RPM]
A value shared by both the Inertia Compensation and Speed Compensation
functions (active only in FV motor control modes), typically supplied by an
external controller that is also providing a rate limited speed reference. The
Speed Rate Reference corresponds to the derivative with respect to time of the
speed reference signal. Units of time are in seconds.
For example, if the controller provides a 10 second reference ramp, the controller
would also supply a Speed Rate Ref value of 1 pu / 10 sec = 0.1 sec-1 while the
reference is accelerating. When the reference is constant, Speed Rate Ref
should be zero.
597 Final Speed Ref Units: Hz RW Real
Final Speed Reference Default: RPM
Displays the speed reference value, after all reference modifications (including Min/Max: 0.00
ramps), that is used as a final reference by the speed regulator. In Open Loop, –/+P27 [Motor NP Hertz]
Sensorless Vector mode, then this value represents the anticipated motor –/+P28 [Motor NP RPM]
operating speed, and may differ slightly from the output frequency value due to
slip compensation.
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
motor is expected to experience at full load. A setting of zero disables slip Min/Max: 0.00 / 1200.00
compensation (not used in closed loop modes with encoder feedback). If the
value of P70 [Autotune] is set to “Calculate”, this value (in addition to others) is
automatically calculated, and cannot be manually adjusted.
622 Slip Comp BW Units: R/S RW Real
Slip Compensation Bandwidth Default: 10.00
Adjusts the bandwidth of a low pass filter used for slip compensation. The Min/Max: 1.00 / 50.00
response time of slip compensation will vary inversely with the setting of this filter.
623 VHzSV SpdTrimReg Units: Hz RW Real
Volts per Hertz Sensorless Vector Speed Trim Regulator RPM
Displays the amount of trim that the slip compensation function dynamically adds Default: 0.00
(based on load) to final speed reference for improved open loop speed control. Min/Max: –/+P27 [Motor NP Hertz] x 8
–/+P28 [Motor NP RPM] x 8
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
StpNoSCrvAcc
Options
SpdRegIntRes
Auto Tach SW
Ramp Disable
SpdRegIntHld
Jog No Integ
Delayed Ref
SpdErrFilter
Ramp Hold
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Default 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 = False
Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 1 = True
Bit 2 “StpNoSCrvAcc” – There are some conditions where the drive may continue to accelerate briefly following a request to stop. This will occur if the
drive was in the process of accelerating on an S Curve when the stop request occurred. This bit enables an option to discontinue acceleration
immediately when the stop request occurs. The S Curve profile that was in process will then change to a linear decel ramp.
Bit 3 “SpdRegIntRes” – When set, the P654 [Spd Reg Int Out] which is the output of the Vector mode speed regulator’s integral term will be forced to
zero. The same result can be achieved by setting the regulator’s integral gain to zero.
Bit 4 “SpdRegIntHld” – When set, the P654 [Spd Reg Int Out] which is the output of the Vector mode speed regulator’s integral term will stop
changing and be held constant. Other conditions in the drive such as a limit condition in P945 [At Limit Status] may have the same result.
Bit 5 “SpdErrFilter” – When set, the speed error filter in the drive’s Vector mode speed regulator will be configured for a single stage low pass filter.
When clear, the error filter will be configured for a two stage low pass filter. The two stage configuration is the normal or default setting for the error
filter.
Bit 6 “Jog No Integ” – When set, the P654 [Spd Reg Int Out] which is the output of the Vector mode speed regulator’s integral term will be forced to
zero while jogging.
Bit 7 “Auto Tach SW” – This bit is used to enable the Automatic Tach Switchover feature. This feature is used to switch motor velocity feedback
sources from the Primary to Alternate source in the event that the primary source fails. This switchover can take place while the drive is running. The
P936 [Drive Status 2] Bit 5 “FdbkLoss SwO” will indicate clear when the Primary source is active and set when the alternate source is active. Clearing
the (Auto Tach SW) bit when the alternate source is active will restore control to the Primary source, provided that the primary source is functioning.
If the (Auto Tach SW) bit remains off, then the Automatic Tach Switchover feature will be disabled.
Bit 8 “Delayed Ref” – When this bit is set, an additional processor scan delay period is inserted between the P594 [Ramped Spd Ref] and the input to
the Speed Reference filter. This delay is intended to be used in applications where multiple, coordinated drives are used. A drive that supplies the
speed reference for use by other drives to follow would typically use this delay. The delay would allow time for the speed reference to reach the other
units before it is acted upon by the sourcing unit, thereby synchronizing the speed reference among all units. When this bit is clear, no speed
reference delay is inserted.
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
5 = “SetCustHeavy”
638 SReg FB FltrGain Default: 0.700 RW Real
Speed Regulator Feedback Filter Gain Min/Max: –5.000 / 20.000
Sets the gain of the speed regulator feedback filter when P637 [SReg FB Fltr Sel]
is set to one of the “Custom” settings (3, 4, or 5).
A gain value of zero results in a filter characteristic that behaves as a first order
low pass. A gain value ranging between zero and one results in a lag type filter. A
gain value greater than one results in a lead type filter. A gain value of one will
disable (bypass) the filter.
639 SReg FB Fltr BW Units: R/S RW Real
Speed Regulator Feedback Filter Bandwidth Default: 35.00
Sets the bandwidth of the speed regulator feedback filter when P637 [SReg FB Min/Max: 0.00 / 3760.00
Fltr Sel] is set to one of the “Custom” settings (3, 4, or 5).
A value of zero will disable (bypass) the filter.
640 Filtered SpdFdbk Units: Hz RW Real
Filtered Speed Feedback RPM
Displays the output of the filter that is applied by P637. Default: 0.00
Min/Max: –/+P27 [Motor NP Hertz] x 8
–/+P28 [Motor NP RPM] x 8
641 Speed Error Units: Hz RW Real
Speed Error Default: RPM
Displays the error (difference) between the P597 [Final Speed Ref] (+) and the Min/Max: 0.00
P640 [Filtered SpdFdbk] (–). This error signal is the primary input for the Vector –/+P27 [Motor NP Hertz] x 8
control mode speed regulator. –/+P28 [Motor NP RPM] x 8
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
filters a signal that is derived from P641 [Speed Error]. The purpose of this filter is
to reduce quantization noise.
When P636 [Speed Reg BW] is set to a non-zero value, this filter will be
automatically set. If P636 [Speed Reg BW] is set to zero, this filter setting must
be manually adjusted. It is normally set to at least 3 to 5 times the value of P636
[Speed Reg BW]. A value of zero disables the filter.
The rules that are used to set the error filter bandwidth in automatic mode are as
follows:
1. If the primary motor velocity feedback is Open Loop, then the error filter is set
to 5 times P636 [Speed Reg BW].
2. If a primary motor velocity feedback device has been selected and P704
[InAdp LdObs Mode] = 1 “InertiaAdapt,” then the error filter is set to 3 times
P636 [Speed Reg BW].
3. If a primary motor velocity feedback device has been selected and P704
[InAdp LdObs Mode] = 0 “Disabled” or 2 “LoadObserver” then the error filter is
using a table look up value determined by the setting of P126 [Pri Vel
FdbkFltr].
Important: When Auto Tach Switchover is enabled through P635 [Spd Options
Cntl], this filter adjustment applies only to the primary feedback source. The filter
setting P651 [AltSpdErr FltrBW] is used for the alternate feedback source.
645 Speed Reg Kp Default: 20.00 RW Real
Speed Regulator Kp Min/Max: 0.00 / P646 [Speed Reg Max Kp]
Sets the proportional gain of the speed regulator (in FV motor control modes).
This value is automatically calculated based on the bandwidth setting in P636
[Speed Reg BW] and P76 [Total Inertia]. The proportional gain may be manually
adjusted by setting P636 [Speed Reg BW] to a value of zero. Proportional gain
has effective scaling of (per unit torque) / (per unit speed). The maximum
allowable value of this parameter is limited by P76 [Total Inertia] and P646 [Spd
Reg Max Kp].
646 Speed Reg Max Kp Default: 3000.00 RW Real
Speed Regulator Maximum Kp Min/Max: 0.00 / 3000.00
Limits the maximum value of P645 [Speed Reg Kp] and P649 [Alt Speed Reg
Kp]. When gains are automatically calculated, this parameter is necessary to limit
the amplification of noise with increased inertia.
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
[Alt Spd Err Filt BW]. See P636 for additional information regarding speed
regulator bandwidth. Also see P635 [Spd Options Ctrl] to enable the Auto Tach
Switchover feature.
649 Alt Speed Reg Kp Default: 20.00 RW Real
Alternate Speed Regulator Kp Min/Max: 0.00 / 100000.00
Provides an independent setting for the same function as P645 [Speed Reg Kp],
but is active only when Automatic Feedback Loss Switchover occurs (indicated by
bit 5 of P936 [Drive Status 2]). This value is automatically calculated based on
the bandwidth setting in P648 [Alt Speed Reg BW] and P76 [Total Inertia]. The
proportional gain may be manually adjusted by setting P648 [Alt Speed Reg BW]
to a value of zero.
650 Alt Speed Reg Ki Default: 50.00 RW Real
Alternate Speed Regulator Ki Min/Max: 0.00 / 100000.00
Provides an independent setting for the same function as P647 [Speed Reg Ki],
but is active only when Automatic Feedback Loss Switchover occurs (indicated by
bit 5 of P936 [Drive Status 2]). This value is automatically calculated based on
the bandwidth setting in P648 [Alt Speed Reg BW], P649 [Alt Speed Reg Kp] and
P653 [Spd Loop Damping]. Integral gain may be manually adjusted by setting
P648 [Alt Speed Reg BW] to a value of zero.
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
“Rate Ref” (2) – Speed compensation function is enabled and uses an externally
generated speed rate signal. The rate of change or derivative of the speed
reference is supplied by P596 [Speed Rate Ref]. This signal is typically supplied
by an external controller when the speed reference ramp is generated external to
the drive.
666 Speed Comp Gain Default: –2.50 RW Real
Speed Compensation Gain Min/Max: –/+32767.00
The Speed Compensation Gain adjusts the magnitude of P667 [Speed Comp
Out]. This gain can be either manually set or automatically determined as part of
automatic gain mode for Vector speed control. Automatic mode can be activated
by selecting a motor speed feedback device in P125 [Pri Vel Fdbk Sel] and
setting a non-zero speed regulator bandwidth in P636 [Speed Reg BW]. In
automatic mode, the gain is calculated internally using a table lookup from the
interrupt times and delays of the speed feedback FIR filter. For any other case –
non-vector control, open loop speed feedback, or zero bandwidth setting, the
speed compensation gain must be manually adjusted.
667 Speed Comp Out Units: Hz RW Real
Speed Compensation Output Default: RPM
Displays the output of the Speed Compensation function. This value will be Min/Max: 0.00
summed with the speed reference, following the application of P555 [Spd Ref –/+P27 [Motor NP Hertz] x 8
Scale]. –/+P28 [Motor NP RPM] x 8
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
Defines the torque limit for the positive torque reference value. The reference will Min/Max: 0.00 / 800.00
not be allowed to exceed this value.
671 Neg Torque Limit Units: % RW Real
Negative Torque Limit Default: –200.00
Defines the torque limit for the negative torque reference value. The reference will Min/Max: –800.00 / 0.00
not be allowed to exceed this value.
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
Default: 100.00
Torque Reference A Analog High Min/Max: –/+800.00
Torque Reference B Analog High
Used only when an analog input is selected as a torque reference according to
P676 or P681. Sets the torque value that corresponds to [Anlg InX Hi] on an I/O
module or on the main control (product dependent). This establishes scaling
throughout the range.
678 Trq Ref A AnlgLo Units: % RW Real
683 Trq Ref B AnlgLo Default: 0.00
Torque Reference A Analog Low Min/Max: –/+800.00
Torque Reference B Analog Low
Used only when an analog input is selected as a torque reference according to
P676 or P681. Sets the torque value that corresponds to [Anlg InX Lo] on an I/O
module or on the main control (product dependent). This establishes scaling
throughout the range.
679 Trq Ref A Mult Default: 1.000 RW Real
684 Trq Ref B Mult Min/Max: –/+1000.000
Torque Reference A Multiplier
Torque Reference B Multiplier
A multiplier that is applied to Torque Reference A and B respectively. A value of 1
leaves the reference unaffected. Negative values invert the reference.
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
reference section. Attenuation is the ratio of the notch filter input signal to its
Torque Reference
output at the P687 [Notch Fltr Freq]. An attenuation of 30 means that the notch
output is 1/30th of the input at the specified frequency.
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
represents the rate of change of the motor speed reference. This setting is
available for applications that supply a ramped speed reference external to the
Inertia Comp
drive.
696 Inertia Acc Gain Default: 1.0000 RW Real
Inertia Acceleration Gain Min/Max: 0.0000 / 2.0000
Sets the acceleration gain for Inertia Compensation. A value of 1 produces 100%
compensation.
697 Inertia Dec Gain Default: 1.0000 RW Real
Inertia Deceleration Gain Min/Max: 0.0000 / 2.0000
Sets the deceleration gain for Inertia Compensation. A value of 1 produces 100%
compensation.
698 Inert Comp LPFBW Units: R/S RW Real
Inertia Compensation Low Pass Filter Bandwidth Default: 35.00
Sets the bandwidth of a low pass filter for inertia compensation. The output of this Min/Max: 0.00 / 2000.00
filter supplies P699 [Inertia Comp Out].
699 Inertia Comp Out Units: % RW Real
Inertia Compensation Output Default: 0.00
Displays the output of the inertia compensation function. The P699 [Inertia Comp Min/Max: –/+800.00
Out] signal is summed with P660 [Spd Reg Out] and becomes an input available
to the P313 [Actv SpTqPs Mode] selector. Inertia compensation provides a
torque feed forward signal during changes in motor speed reference.
700 Ext Ramped Ref Units: Hz RW Real
External Ramped Reference Default: RPM
This parameter is meant for an external motor speed ramp input signal. This Min/Max: 0.00
signal will be used by the inertia compensation function when P695 [InertiaComp –/+P27 [Motor NP Hertz] x 8
Mode] has selected Ext Ramp Ref (2). –/+P28 [Motor NP RPM] x 8
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
P708 [InertiaTrqAdd] is zero so the motor torque reference is not affected. P707
[Load Estimate] is still valid, provided that the drive is in Vector Mode, using a
motor speed feedback device, and a valid P76 [Total Inertia] is used.
“InertiaAdapt” (1) – Inertia Adaption function is enabled. The Inertia Adaption
function will provide enhanced stability, higher bandwidths and dynamic stiffness.
Inertia Adaption is especially useful in systems with a gear-box that become, in
effect, disconnected from the load. Inertia Adaption may also be used for motors
with very little inertia that otherwise would lack dynamic stiffness, even at high
bandwidths. The output of the Inertia Adaption function P708 [InertiaTrqAdd], will
subtract from the motor torque reference.
“LoadObserver” (2) – Load Observer function is enabled. The Load Observer
function removes or greatly reduces the effects of load disturbances and provides
quicker system response. The output of the Load Observer function is similar to
P707 [Load Estimate], but has a filter setting determined by P711 [Load Observer
BW]. The Load Observer’s output signal will add to the motor torque reference.
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
Displays the output of the Inertia Adaption function. This value will be subtracted Min/Max: –/+800.00
from the motor torque reference, with the result displayed as P689 [Filtered Trq
Friction Comp
Ref]. The inertia adaption function will be active when operating in Vector Control
mode with a motor speed feedback device and P704 [InAdp LdObs Mode] = 1
“InertiaAdapt.” A value of 100% represents rated motor torque.
709 IA LdObs Delay Default: 3 = “50R/S Noise” RW 32-bit
Inertia Adaption Load Observer Delay Options: 0 = “190R/S Noise” Integer
Adjusts a filter setting that is applied to the active motor velocity feedback source. 1 = “160R/S Noise”
The purpose of this filter is to reduce the level of noise present in the feedback 2 = “100R/S Noise”
signal. Note that this filter is the same type but separate from the filters used to 3 = “50R/S Noise”
provide P127 [Pri Vel Feedback] and P130 [Alt Vel Feedback]. The derivative of 4 = “25R/S Noise”
the Sys Control Delay filtered motor velocity signal will be a Motor Acceleration
5 = “12R/S Noise”
Feedback signal. The Motor Acceleration Feedback is applied to the Inertia
6 = “6R/S Noise”
Adaption and Load Observer/ Load Estimate functions.
7 = “3R/S Noise”
This is moving average type filter that has a delay setting of N, where N is an
integer number (0, 1, 2 …). A setting of zero provides no filtering and no delay.
Larger values of N result in more filtering and more delay. The best setting for this
filter will depend on the level of noise present in the feedback signal and the
bandwidth setting of the velocity regulator.
710 InertAdptFiltBW Units: R/S RO Real
Inertia Adaption Filter Bandwidth Default: 50.00
Sets the bandwidth of a low pass filter located in the output of the vector control Min/Max: 0.00 / 1000.00
speed regulator and used in connection with the Inertia Adaption function. The
bandwidth of this filter should typically be set to five times the bandwidth of the
speed regulator. This setting is automatically made when the Inertia Adaption
function is active and the speed regulator bandwidth (P636 [Speed Reg BW]), is
set to a non-zero value. If the speed regulator bandwidth is set to zero, then this
filter setting must be manually adjusted.
711 Load Observer BW Units: R/S RO Real
Load Observer Bandwidth Default: 40.00
Sets the bandwidth of a low pass filter located in the output of the Load Observer Min/Max: 1.00 / 1000.00
function. Typical filter settings range from 10 radians/sec to 150 radians/sec with
the higher values being more responsive to disturbances but with increased
system noise. There is no nominal best setting, but 40 rad/sec is a suggested
starting point. This selection may not function well in sloppy geared systems.
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
ZeroFFSpdRef
Options
Ref Complete
SpdFFRef En
PTP Int Hold
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Default 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 = False
1 = True
Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Displays the current operating status of the Pt-Pt Position Planner in the Position Referencing.
Bit 0 “ZeroFFSpdRef” – Indicates the speed feed forward reference P783 [PTP Speed FwdRef] is zero.
Bit 1 “Ref Complete” – Indicates the position pt-pt feedback P777 [PTP Feedback] reaches the position pt-pt reference P784 [PTP Command], and
the speed forward reference P783 [PTP Speed FwdRef] reaches zero.
Bit 2 “P2P Int Hold” – Indicates the position pt-pt planner integrator is holding. Read back of the Pt-Pt integral hold bit P770 [PTP Control] Bit 4 “Intgrtr
Hold”.
Bit 3 “SpdFFRef En” – Indicates the speed feed forward reference P783 [PTP Speed FwdRef] is active.
721 Position Control
Position Control
PsnWtch2Arm
PsnWtch1Arm
PsnWatch2Dir
PsnWatch1Dir
Options
Offset ReRef
Add Spd Ref
OffsetVel En
Intgrtr Hold
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Intgrtr En
Zero Psn
Default 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 = False
1 = True
POSITION CONTROL
Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Position Cfg/Sts
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
PsnW2Detect
PsnW1Detect
Offset ReRef
InPsn Detect
Integ Lmt Lo
Integ Lmt Hi
Spd Lmt Lo
Intgrtr Hold
OffsetIntgtr
Spd Lmt Hi
Psn Intgrtr
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Default 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 = False
1 = True
Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Bit 8 “Intgrtr Hold” – Indicates the position Integrator is held in present state
Bit 9 “PsnW1Detect” – Indicates the position watch 1 has detected motor position equal to its setpoint, from the proper direction.
Bit 10 “PsnW2Detect” – Indicates the position watch 2 has detected motor position equal to its setpoint, from the proper direction.
Bit 11 “InPsn Detect” – Indicates P835 [Psn Error] is within the position band specified by the in-position band P726 [In Pos Psn Band]
725 Zero Position Default: 0 RW 32-bit
Zero Position Min/Max: –2147483648 / 2147483647 Integer
Sets the absolute user zero position. When the zero position bit P721 [Position
Control] Bit 4 “Zero Psn” is set, P836 [Psn Actual] accumulates the value of P847
[Psn Fdbk] - the P725 [Zero Position], and P836 [Psn Actual] becomes zero when
P847 [Psn Fdbk] is at the zero position. The homing function also sets the value
after homing process is completed.
726 In Pos Psn Band 0 RW 32-bit
In Positive Position Bandwidth 0 / 2147483647 Integer
Sets the overall bandwidth of the in position detector. The detector sets the
in-position detect bit P724 [Psn Reg Status] Bit 11 “InPsn Detect” when P835
[Psn Error] is within this position band for a sufficient time specified by the
in-position dwell time P727 [In Pos Psn Dwell]. A modest hysterics count is added
to the position bandwidth after the position error is within specified limits.
727 In Pos Psn Dwell Default: 0.0040 RW Real
In Positive Position Dwell Min/Max: 0.0001 / 10.0000
Sets dwell time for the in position detector. Position error must be within the value
specified by the in-position band P726 [In Pos Psn Band] for this amount of time
before the in-position detector sets the in-position detect bit P724 [Psn Reg
Status] Bit 11 “InPsn Detect”. A momentary out-of-position indication will reset
the internal timer and clear the in-position detect bit P724 [Psn Reg Status] Bit 11
“InPsn Detect”.
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
Home Request
Home Enabled
Options
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
At Home
Homing
Default 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 = Disabled
1 = Enabled
Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Options
Hold At Home
Home Marker
Psn Redefine
Return Home
Home DI Inv
Find Home
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Home DI
Default 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 = Disabled
1 = Enabled
Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
POSITION CONTROL
Bit 0 “Find Home” – Puts the drive in the homing mode. Setting this bit requests the homing function and sets homing request bit P730 [Homing
Status] Bit 0 “Home Request”. This bit needs a toggle to reset the the homing function.
Bit 1 “Home DI” – Configures the homing function to use a switch (digital input). When this bit is on and Bit 2 “Home Marker” is off, the homing
function is configured as home switch mode. When this bit is on and Bit 2 “Home Marker” is on, the homing function is configured as home
marker-switch mode.
Bit 2 “Home Marker” – Configures the homing function to use a marker input. When this bit is on and Bit 1 “Home DI” is off, the homing function is
configured as home marker mode. When this bit is on and Bit 1 “Home DI” is on, the homing function is configured as home marker-switch mode.
Bit 3 “Return Home” – Configures the homing function as return home mode. The drive returns to the actual home position P737 [Actual Home Psn].
Bit 4 “Psn Redefine” – Sets the position feedback P847 [Psn Fdbk] to the actual home position P737 [Actual Home Psn].
Bit 5 “Homing Alarm” – Enables the home running alarm when the homing function is active.
Bit 6 “Home DI Inv” – Changes polarity of the switch input (digital input).
Bit 7 “Hold At Home” – Configures the drive to return to the home position after completing the homing function. A satrt command is required for the
drive to run again.
732 DI Find Home Default: 0.00 RW 32-bit
Digital Input Find Home Min/Max: 0.00 / 159999.15 Integer
Sets a digital input port for the “Find Home” function.
733 DI Redefine Psn Units: 0.00 RW 32-bit
Digital Input Redefine Position Default: 0.00 / 159999.15 Integer
Sets a digital input port for the redefine position function. The digital input Min/Max:
assigned by this parameter is equivalent to the position redefine bit P731
[Homing Control] Bit 4 “Psn Redefine”.
734 DI OL Home Limit Units: 0.00 RW 32-bit
Digital Input Open Loop Home Limit Default: 0.00 / 159999.15 Integer
Sets a digital input port for the limit switch of open loop homing function. Polarity Min/Max:
of digital input (rising or falling edge) is specified by the home DI invert bit [P701
Bit06].
735 Find Home Speed Units: Hz RW Real
Find Home Speed RPM
Sets the speed and direction that are active when the “Find Home” moves P731 Default: P27 [Motor NP Hz] x 0.1
[Homing Control] Bit 6 “Home DI Inv” is active. The sign of the value defines P28 [Motor NP RPM] x 0.1
direction (“+” = Forward, “–” = Reverse). Min/Max: P27 [Motor NP Hz] x 0.5
P28 [Motor NP RPM] x 0.5
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
Provides position feedback source for the position watch function. The position
Position Watch
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
position reference to the position regulator when the Spd/Torq/Pos mode P313
[Actv SpTqPs Mode] is the position direct mode (Option 10) and the position
reference select P765 [Psn Ref Select] is the set point.
767 Psn Direct Ref Default: 0 RW 32-bit
Position Direct Reference Min/Max: –2147483648 / 2147483647 Integer
Indicates position direct reference selected by the position reference select P765
[Psn Ref Select].
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
Options
Vel Override
Intgrtr Hold
Preset Psn
Ref Pause
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Ref Sync
Move
Default 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 = False
1 = True
Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Bit 0 “Vel Override” – applies the velocity overload P788 [PTP Vel Override] to the forward velocity limit P785 [PTP Fwd Vel Lmt] and the reverse
velocity limit P786 [PTP Rev Vel Lmt] as a gain. When the velocity overload P788 [PTP Vel Override] is 1.1 and the forward velocity limit P785 [PTP
Fwd Vel Lmt] is 30 Hz, the bit sets the maximum forward velocity to 33 Hz.
Bit 1 “Move” – sets scaled point-point position reference to the point-point position command P784 [PTP Command]. When the point-point mode
selection P771 [PTP Mode] is absolute mode (Option 0), the absolute position is set to the point-point position command P784 when the bit rises.
POSITION CONTROL
When the point-point mode selection P771 [PTP Mode] is index mode (Option 1), the index position is set to the point-point position command P784
Point to Point
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
Options
Accel Comp
PTP Enable
Prof Enable
PLL Enable
Velocity FF
Ext Vel FF
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
0 = False
Default 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 = True
POSITION CONTROL
Phase Lock Loop
Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
Indicates position output. This parameter is precisely in phase with the input
physical device.
810 PLL Enc Out Adv Default: 0 RW 32-bit
Phase Locked Loop Encoder Output Advanced Min/Max: –2147483648 / 2147483647 Integer
Indicates position advanced output. This parameter is one position sample in
advance of the position output P809 [PLL Enc Out].
811 PLL EPR Output Default: 1048576 RW 32-bit
Phase Locked Loop Edges Per Revolution Output Min/Max: 1 / 67108864 Integer
Sets edges per revolution of virtual the physical output device.
812 PLL Rvls Output Default: 1 RW 32-bit
Phase Locked Loop Revolutions Output Min/Max: 1 / 2000000 Integer
Sets revolution of the output encoder. This parameter must be coordinated with
the revolution of the input encoder P805 [PLL Rvls Input] to resolve the gear-ratio
between input revolutions and output (virtual) revolutions. The ratio of input to
output revolutions can always be resolved into integer values and should be
reduced to their lowest common factor.
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
Subsequent changes to this value will be relative to the latched value. See the
Position Offset
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
divided by the load feedback divider P826 [LdPsn Fdbk Div] to reflect the load
Ld Psn Fdbk Scal
pulse count to the motor (effectively removing the gear box ratio). The
accumulated position values P836 [Psn Actual] and the position load actual P837
[Psn Load Actual] - will be equal if the ratio is set properly. There may be some
difference due to lost motion in the gear train, but there should not be an
accumulated difference. It is often necessary to count gear teeth as gear box
manufacturers often approximate exact ratios with decimal numbers. Enter a
negative value in the numerator to account for reversed motor rotation.
826 LdPsn Fdbk Div Default: 1 RW 32-bit
Load Position Feedback Division Min/Max: 1 / 2000000 Integer
Sets denominator of the load EGR function.
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
Sets negative limit of the position regulator integral output. Min/Max: –800.00 / 0.00
842 PsnReg IntgrlOut Units: Hz RW Real
Position Regulation Integral Output RPM
Indicates output of the position regulator integral channel after the limit function. Default: 0.00
Min/Max: –/+P27 [Motor NP Hertz] x 8
–/+P28 [Motor NP RPM] x 8
843 PsnReg Spd Out Units: Hz RW Real
Position Regulation Speed Output RPM
Indicates final output of the position regulator. Default: 0.00
Min/Max: –/+P27 [Motor NP Hertz] x 8
–/+P28 [Motor NP RPM] x 8
844 PReg Pos Spd Lmt Units: % RW Real
Position Regulation Positive Speed Limit Default: 10.00
Sets positive speed limit of total position regulator output. Min/Max: 0.00 / 800.00
845 PReg Neg Spd Lmt Units: % RW Real
Position Regulation Negative Speed Limit Default: –10.00
Sets negative speed limit of total position regulator output. Min/Max: –800.00 / 0.00
846 Psn Reg Droop Units: Secs RW Real
Position Regulation Droop Default: 0.00
Sets position droop which limits the low frequency gain of the position regulators Min/Max: 0.00 / 25.00
integral channel to a value of (1/droop). This parameter provides a means to fine
tune the stability for load mounted feedback devices where lost motion may
cause a problem. Typically, the position droop will have a value that is less than
(1/position gain), perhaps even zero for tightly coupled loads. The position droop
has a gain value of (P.U. position) / (P.U. speed). Note: 1 P.U. position is the
distance traveled in 1 sec. at base motor speed.
847 Psn Fdbk Default: 0 RW 32-bit
Position Feedback Min/Max: –2147483648 / 2147483647 Integer
Indicates the accumulated pulse count of the position feedback selected by the
position feedback select [P135].
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
SpdRef Sel 2
SpdRef Sel 1
SpdRef Sel 0
Decel Time 2
Decel Time 1
Accel Time 2
Accel Time 1
Options
Clear Faults
Coast Stop
Climit Stop
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reverse
Forward
Manual
Jog 2
Jog 1
Start
Stop
Run
Default 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
Bit 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
0 = False
COMMUNICATION
1 = True
Comm Control
SpdRef Sel 2
SpdRef Sel 1
SpdRef Sel 0
Decel Time 2
Decel Time 1
Decel Time 2
Decel Time 1
Options
Accel Time 2
Accel Time 1
Accel Time 2
Accel Time 1
Clear Faults
Clear Faults
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reverse
Reverse
Forward
Forward
Manual
Manual
Jog 1
Jog 1
Start
Start
Stop
Stop
Default 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
Bit 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
0 = False
1 = True
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Options
Digital In
Security
Port 6
Port 5
Port 4
Port 3
Port 2
Port 1
Default 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 = False
Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 1 = True
Options
Digital In
Security
Port 14
Port 13
Port 6
Port 5
Port 4
Port 3
Port 2
Port 1
Default 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 = False
COMMUNICATION
Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 1 = True
Security
Reserved
Options
Security
Port 14
Port 13
Port 9
Port 8
Port 7
Port 6
Port 5
Port 4
Port 3
Port 2
Port 1
Default 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 1 1 0 0 = False
Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 1 = True
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Options
Port 14
Port 13
Port 9
Port 8
Port 7
Port 6
Port 5
Port 4
Port 3
Port 2
Port 1
Default 0 1 1 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 0 0 = False
Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 1 = True
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Options
Digital In
Port 14
Port 13
Port 6
Port 5
Port 4
Port 3
Port 2
Port 1
Default 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 = False
Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 1 = True
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Options
Digital In
Port 14
Port 13
Port 6
Port 5
Port 4
Port 3
Port 2
Port 1
Default 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 = False
Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 1 = True
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Options
Digital In
Port 14
Port 13
Port 6
Port 5
Port 4
Port 3
Port 2
Port 1
Default 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 = False
Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 1 = True
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Options
Digital In
Port 14
Port 13
Port 6
Port 5
Port 4
Port 3
Port 2
Port 1
Default 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 = False
Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 1 = True
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Options
Digital In
Port 14
Port 13
Port 6
Port 5
Port 4
Port 3
Port 2
Port 1
Default 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 = False
Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 1 = True
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Options
Digital In
Port 14
Port 13
Port 6
Port 5
Port 4
Port 3
Port 2
Port 1
COMMUNICATION
Default 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 = False
Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 1 = True
Owners
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Options
Digital In
Port 14
Port 13
Port 6
Port 5
Port 4
Port 3
Port 2
Port 1
Default 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 = False
Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 1 = True
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
Options
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Profilier
Faulted
Enable
Safety
Alarm
Sleep
Stop
Default 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 = False
Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 1 = True
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
Precharge
Options
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Database
Profilier
Faulted
Startup
Enable
Safety
Alarm
Sleep
Stop
Default 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 = False
Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 1 = True
Command Dir
PositionMode
Options
Torque Mode
Speed Mode
SpdRef Bit 4
SpdRef Bit 3
SpdRef Bit 2
SpdRef Bit 1
SpdRef Bit 0
Decelerating
Bus Frq Reg
Accelerating
DC Braking
Enable On
DB Active
Actual Dir
Reserved
Motor OL
At Speed
Cur Limit
Stopping
At Home
Running
Jogging
At Limit
Faulted
Manual
Regen
Ready
Active
Alarm
Default 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
Bit 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
0 = Condition False
Table 795A: Reference Status Table 795B: Exceleration Status
1 = Condition True
Bit 14 13 12 Input Filter Setting Bit 11 10 9 Input Filter Setting
0 0 0 Ref A Auto 0 0 0 Port 0 (TB)
0 0 1 Ref B Auto 0 0 1 Port 1
DIAGNOSTICS
AuRstrCntDwn
Options
PrchrgClosed
PID FB Loss
AutoRstr Act
HS Fan On
Autotuning
Flux Brake
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Options
UnderVoltage
AuxFdbkLoss
PosFdbkLoss
InPhaseLoss
ExtPrchrgErr
GndWarning
PriFdbkLoss
AltFdbkLoss
Shear Pin 2
Shear Pin 1
Power Loss
Decel Inhib
Load Loss
Reserved
Motor OL
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
FreqOSNegLmt
Options
FreqOSPosLmt
PsnReg LoSpd
MaxSpeed Lmt
Therm RegLmt
PsnReg LoLmt
Regen PwrLmt
PsnReg HiSpd
TrqCurNegLmt
PsnReg HiLmt
FlxCurNegLmt
TrqPrvNegLmt
PWM FreqLmt
BusVltgFVLmt
TrqCurPosLmt
FlxCurPosLmt
TrqPrvPosLmt
Mtrng PwrLmt
Cur Rate Lmt
OverSpd Lmt
DB Res Limit
Freq Lo Lmt
Mtr Vltg Lkg
Current Lmt
Freq Hi Lmt
Cur Lmt FV
Economize
Default 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
Bit 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
0 = False
1 = True
Bit 0 “Current Lmt” – Scalar current limit is adjusting the output frequency
Bit 1 “Bus Vltg Lmt” – Scalar bus voltage limit is adjusting the output frequency
Bit 2 “MaxSpeed Lmt” – Motor speed reference is limited to maximum forward speed or maximum reverse speed
Bit 3 “OverSpd Lmt” – Motor speed reference positive (+) trim is at maximum speed limit plus or minus (+/-) the overspeed limit
Bit 4 “Spd Reg Lmt” – The output of the drive’s speed regulator has reached limit
Bit 5 “Freq Hi Lmt” – Scalar control inner ramp high limit is active
Bit 6 “Freq Lo Lmt” – Scalar control inner ramp low limit is active
Bit 7 “FreqOSPosLmt” – Scalar control inner ramp positive (+) overspeed limit is active
Bit 8 “FreqOSNegLmt” – Scalar control inner ramp negative (-) overspeed limit is active
Bit 9 “Flux Braking” – Flux braking is active
Bit 10 “Economize” – Economize is active
Bit 11 “PWM FreqLmt” – PWM frequency is reduced by the thermal regulator
DIAGNOSTICS
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Options
Slot 8
Slot 7
Slot 6
Slot 5
Slot 4
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
Enable
Default 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 0 = Condition False
Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 1 = Condition True
Options
UnderVoltage
AuxFdbkLoss
PosFdbkLoss
InPhaseLoss
ExtPrchrgErr
PriFdbkLoss
AltFdbkLoss
Shear Pin 2
Shear Pin 1
Power Loss
Decel Inhib
Load Loss
Reserved
Reserved
Motor OL
Default 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
Fault/Alarm Info
0 = False
DIAGNOSTICS
Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 1 = True
Options
SinkUnderTmp
TrqPrvSpdBnd
AuRstExhaust
IXOVoltRange
IRVoltsRange
TPEnclsCnfg
Ground Fault
Excess Load
HW OverCur
Overspd Lmt
Prchrg Open
TransistorOT
SW OverCur
Heatsink OT
SafetyBrdFlt
OverVoltage
Aux InputFlt
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Drive OL
Default 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
Bit 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
0 = False
1 = True
954 Status1 at Fault
Status 1 at Fault
Captures and displays P935 [Drive Status 1] bit pattern at the time of the last fault.
AtZero Speed
Command Dir
PositionMode
Options
Torque Mode
Speed Mode
SpdRef Bit 4
SpdRef Bit 3
SpdRef Bit 2
SpdRef Bit 1
SpdRef Bit 0
Decelerating
Bus Frq Reg
Accelerating
DC Braking
Enable On
DB Active
Actual Dir
Reserved
Motor OL
At Speed
Cur Limit
Stopping
At Home
Running
Jogging
At Limit
Faulted
Manual
Regen
Ready
Active
Alarm
Default 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
Bit 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
0 = False
1 = True
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
FdbkLoss SwO
AuRstrCntDwn
Options
PrchrgClosed
PID FB Loss
AutoRstr Act
HS Fan On
Decel Rate
Accel Rate
Autotuning
Flux Brake
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Default 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 = Condition False
Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 1 = Condition True
Captures and displays the DC bus voltage of the drive at the time of the last fault.
959 Alarm Status A
Alarm Status A
Indicates the occurrence of exception events that have been configured as alarm conditions. These events are from [Exception Event1].
OutPhaseLoss
Options
UnderVoltage
AuxFdbkLoss
PosFdbkLoss
Gnd Warning
InPhaseLoss
PriFdbkLoss
AltFdbkLoss
Shear Pin 2
Shear Pin 1
Power Loss
Decel Inhib
Load Loss
Reserved
Reserved
Motor OL
Default 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 = False
Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 1 = True
Options
StartOnPwrUp
CurLmt Reduc
Not Home Set
Gnd Warning
Homing Actv
Heatsink OT
Profile Actv
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
IGBT OT
Drive OL
Waking
Default 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 = False
Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 1 = True
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
FluxAmpsRang
Options
VHzNegSlope
IXOVoltRange
VHz Incmpble
BrakeSlipped
IRVltg Range
VHzBossLmt
DigIn Cnfg C
DigIn Cnfg B
TrqProvCflct
BipolarCflct
FdbkSelErr
Sleep Cfg
Reserved
Reserved
Frq Cflct
Default 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 = False
Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 1 = True
Bit 11 “HH HW Ver” – Indicates a non-configurable High Horsepower hardware version fault.
Bit 12 “HH CurUnblnc” – Indicates a non-configurable High Horsepower output current unbalanced fault.
Bit 13 “HH VltUnblnc” – Indicates a non-configurable High Horsepower Bus voltage unbalanced fault.
Bit 14 “HH Bus Data” – Indicates when Communication Bus data are mismatched between left side unit and right side unit.
Bit 21 “Drive Homing” – When the drive is in “Drive Homing” mode (parameter P721 [Position Control] bit 24 “Find Home” or bit 27 “Return Home” is
set to “1”) this alarm is triggered and the drive moves to a home position automatically.
Bit 28 “+/- 12v Pwr” – Identifies when the12V dc control voltage is outside the tolerance range. The positive voltage power exceeds +15.50 V dc and
the negative voltage power exceeds -15.50V dc.
Bit 29 “AnlgIn1 Loss” – Indicates a non-configurable Analog Input 1 loss fault.
Fault/Alarm Info
DIAGNOSTICS
Options
AuxFdbkLoss
UnderVoltage
PosFdbkLoss
Ground Warn
InPhaseLoss
PriFdbkLoss
AltFdbkLoss
Shear Pin 2
Shear Pin 1
Power Loss
Decel Inhib
Load Loss
Load Loss
Reserved
Motor OL
Default 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 = False
Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 1 = True
Options
StartOnPwrUp
CurLmt Reduc
Not Home Set
Gnd Warning
Homing Actv
Heatsink OT
Profile Actv
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
IGBT OT
Drive OL
Waking
Default 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 = False
Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 1 = True
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
Peak1 Peak
Options
Peak1 Hold
Peak1 Set
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Default 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Bit 0 “Peak1 Peak” – 0 = Capture minimum value of the input signal. 1 = Capture maximum value of the input signal.
Bit 1 “Peak1 Hold” – 0 = Monitor input. 1 = Ignore input and hold output at present value. This bit is overridden by Bit 2.
Bit 2 “Peak1 Set” – 0 = Resume normal capture of the input signal value (assuming Bit 1 is also = 0). The preset signal will be used as a starting value
to compare against further changes in the input signal level. 1 = Force output of the peak detect function to equal the signal selected by
[PkDtctXPresetSel].
1040 Peak 1 Change
Peak 1 Change
Status of the peak detectors.
Peak1Change
Options
Peak Direction
DIAGNOSTICS
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
Peak1 Peak
Options
Peak1 Hold
Peak1 Set
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Default 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 = False
Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 1 = True
Bit 0 “Peak1 Peak” – 0 = Capture minimum value of the input signal. 1 = Capture maximum value of the input signal.
Bit 1 “Peak1 Hold” – 0 = Monitor input. 1 = Ignore input and hold output at present value. This bit is overridden by Bit 2.
Bit 2 “Peak1 Set” – 0 = Resume normal capture of the input signal value (assuming Bit 1 is also = 0). The preset signal will be used as a starting value
Peak Direction
DIAGNOSTICS
to compare against further changes in the input signal level. 1 = Force output of the peak detect function to equal the signal selected by
[PkDtctXPresetSel].
1045 Peak 2 Change
Peak 2 Change
Status of the peak detectors.
Peak1Change
Options
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
Anti Windup
Percent Ref
Zero Clamp
Options
Preload Int
Stop Mode
Ramp Ref
Fdbk Sqrt
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Default 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 = False
Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 1 = True
PID InvError
Options
PID Enable
PID Reset
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
PID Hold
Default 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 = False
Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 1 = True
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
PID Enabled
Options
PID In Limit
PID Reset
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
PID Hold
Default 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 = False
Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 1 = True
APPLICATIONS
Process PID
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
Options
BrkSlipEncls
Encoderless
BrkSlipStart
TP Enable
Micro Psn
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Preload
Default 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 = Disabled
Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 1 = Enabled
Bit 2 “Cnfg Enable” – A “1” allows the Micro Position digital input to change the speed command while the drive is running.
Bit 3 “TP Encdless” – “0” uses the last torque for preload. “1” uses “TorqRef A” if commanded direction is forward and “TorqRef B” for reverse.
Bit 4 “TP Load Lim” – Enables drive to perform load calculation at base speed. Drive will then limit operation above base speed depending on load.
Bit 5 “TP EnclsSlip” – A “1” Disables the partial Brake Slip routine from the drive when encoderless is selected.
Bit 6 “BrkSlipStart” – Starts drive if Brake slippage is detected.
1101 Trq Prove Setup
Torque Prove Setup
Allows control of specific torque proving functions through a communication device.
End Stop Fwd
End Stop Rev
Options
Float Micro
Decel Fwd
Decel Rev
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Fast Stop
Default 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 = Disabled
Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 1 = Enabled
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
RefLoadLmted
Options
DecelLmtActv
LoadTestActv
EndLimitActv
BrkSlip1 Alm
Encoderless
Micro Psn
Brake Set
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Default 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 = Disabled
Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 1 = Enabled
actual speed (from a feedback device). When this value is exceeded for the P28 [Motor NP RPM] x 0.0334
amount of time in P1106, a fault will occur. Min/Max: P27 x 0.0016 / P27 x 0.25
P28 x 0.0016 / P28 x 0.25
1106 SpdBand Intgrtr Units: Secs RW Real
Speed Band Integer Default: 0.060
The amount of time for which the actual speed is allowed to exceed P1105 Min/Max: 0.001 / 0.200
[Speed Dev Band] before a fault occurs.
1107 Brk Release Time Units: Secs RW Real
Brake Release Time Default: 0.100
Sets the time between the brake release command and when the drive begins to Min/Max: 0.000 / 10.000
accelerate. In Encoderless mode, this parameter sets the time to release the
brake after drive starts.
1108 Brk Set Time Units: Secs RW Real
Brake Set Time Default: 0.100
Defines the amount of delay time between commanding the brake to be set and Min/Max: 0.000 / 10.000
the start of brake proving.
1109 Brk Alarm Travel Default: 1.00 RW Real
Brake Alarm Travel Min/Max: 0.00 / 1000.00
Sets the number of motor shaft revolutions allowed during the brake slippage
test. Drive torque is reduced to check for brake slippage. When slippage occurs,
the drive allows this number of motor shaft revolutions before regaining control.
Not used in Encoderless TorqProve mode.
1110 Brk Slip Count Default: 250.00 RW Real
Brake Slip Count Min/Max: 0.00 / 65535.00
Sets the number of encoder counts to define a brake slippage condition.
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
Options
PositionMode
Restart Step
Vel Override
In Position
Step Bit 4
Step Bit 3
Step Bit 2
Step Bit 1
Step Bit 0
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Complete
Running
Resume
Stopped
Enabled
Holding
Dwell
Default 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
Bit 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
0 = False
1 = True
Bit 0 “Step Bit 0”
Bit 1 “Step Bit 1”
Bit 2 “Step Bit 2”
APPLICATIONS
Bit 4 “Step Bit 4” – Bit 0 through Bit 4 indicate executing step number in the move table in binary format.
Bit 8 “Enabled” – indicates that the profile control logic is enabled. When the drive is started with the profiler selection (Option 8) in the speed/torque/
position mode P313 [Actv SpTqPs Mode], this bit turns on.
Bit 9 “Running” – indicates that the profile control logic is in running state.
Bit 10 “PositionMode” – indicates that the profile control logic is using position control logic.
Bit 11 “Dwell” – indicates that the profile control logic is in dwell state.
Bit 12 “Holding” – indicates that the profile control logic is in holding states
Bit 13 “In Position” – indicates that the target position has been reached at the completion of a move. The in position bandwidth P721 [Position
Control] can be adjusted to affect when this bit is set with respect to the target position. This bit will be cleared when a new move is begun
Bit 14 “Complete” – indicates that all steps in the move table have been executed and a step with a End action has been reached. The profile control
logic is complete. This bit will be cleared when the profile is first enabled.
Bit 15 “Stopped” – indicates that the profile control logic stops the drive following the Complete status [P1170 Bit14] and any additional dwell time
specified for the End step. This bit will be cleared when a new profile is begun.
Bit 16 “Resume” – indicates that an existing step is to resume execution when the profile is enabled. A previously running step will then be allowed to
complete. When the bit is clear, the profile will begin at its Starting Step.
Bit 17 “Restart Step” – follows the state of the restart step bit in P1213 [Profile Command] Bit 10 “Restart Step”.
Bit 18 “Vel Override” – follows the state of the velocity override bit in P1213 [Profile Command] Bit 9 “Vel Override”.
Bit 19 “Home Not Set” – indicates that the home position is not defined and the move table contains a position absolute move type. When this bit is
set the profile will not be allowed to execute. This bit will be cleared when either a homing function or position redefine function is completed.
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
Options
Prof Run Alm
Restart Step
Vel Override
StrStepSel4
StrStepSel3
StrStepSel2
StrStepSel1
StrStepSel0
Hold Step
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Default 0 0 0 1 1 0 0 0 0 0 Reserved
0 0 0 0 0 0 0 = Disabled
1 = Enabled
Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Bit 0 “StrStepSel0”
Bit 1 “StrStepSel1”
APPLICATIONS
Bit 2 “StrStepSel2”
Profiling
Bit 3 “StrStepSel3”
Bit 4 “StrStepSel4” – Bit 0 through Bit 4 set initial or starting step in the move table in binary format. A starting step value of zero results in no motion
when the drive is enabled.
Bit 8 “Hold Step” – When the drive is enabled with this bit is set, the drive starts and runs at zero velocity. The starting step is not executed until the
‘Hold Step’ bit is removed.
For non-blended moves, the drive will hold zero speed and/or current position. This does not stop the drive. For blended moves, the drive will continue
to run at the step velocity. If the Hold Step bit is removed, then the conditions required to complete the step can be evaluated.
Bit 9 “Vel Override” – can be used to rescale all move velocities by the velocity override [P1176]. When this bit is off, a scale factor of 1 is used.
Bit 10 “Restart Step” – can be used to disable a currently executing profile. This bit forces the current step to reset to the starting step value.
Bit 11 “NtHomeSetAlm” – sets condition to indicate the “home position not set” alarm. The absolute position type will work without home position if the
bit is off. Set on as default.
Bit 12 “Prof Run Alm” – sets condition to indicate the profile running alarm during the drive is running. Set on as default.
1215 Counts Per Unit Default: 1 RW 32-bit
Counts Per Unit Min/Max: 1 / 2200000000 Integer
Sets number of position feedback counts per unit of machine travel (ex, 1024
encoder edge counts per inch). This parameter is used to scale position targets
from their entered values of units to internal units of encoder edge counts. This
parameter is also used to convert actual motor position from encoder edge
counts back into the desired units for display in P1212 [Units Traveled].
1216 ProfVel Override Units: % RW Real
Profile Velocity Override Default: 100.00
Sets multiplier for all move velocities when the velocity override function is Min/Max: 10.00 / 150.00
selected [P1173 Bit09]. This parameter is typically set to a value less than 1.
When the velocity override bit [P1173 Bit09] is off, a scale factor of 1 is used.
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
Vel Override
StrStepSel4
StrStepSel3
StrStepSel2
StrStepSel1
StrStepSel0
Options
AbortProfile
Abort Step
Hold Step
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Step 16
Step 15
Step 14
Step 13
Step 12
Step 11
Step 10
Step 9
Step 8
Step 7
Step 6
Step 5
Step 4
Step 3
Step 2
Step 1
Default 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
Bit 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
0 = False
1 = True
Bit 0 “Hold Step” – sets polarity of the digital input for the hold step, P1218 [DI Hold Step].
Bit 1 “Abort Step” – sets polarity of the digital input for abort step, P1219 [DI Abort Step].
Bit 2 “AbortProfile” – sets polarity of the digital input for abort profile, P1220 [DI Abort Profile].
Bit 3 “Vel Override” – sets polarity of the digital input for velocity override, P1221 [DI Vel Override].
Bit 4 “StrStepSel0” – sets polarity of the digital input for start step 1, P1222 [DI StrtStep Sel0].
Bit 5 “StrStepSel1” – sets polarity of the digital input for start step 2, P1223 [DI StrtStep Sel1].
Bit 6 “StrStepSel2” – sets polarity of the digital input for start step 3, P1224 [DI StrtStep Sel2].
Bit 7 “StrStepSel3” – sets polarity of the digital input for start step 4, P1225 [DI StrtStep Sel3].
Bit 8 “StrStepSel4” – sets polarity of the digital input for start step 5, P1226 [DI StrtStep Sel4]
Bit 9 “Step 1” – sets polarity of the digital input for move step 1, P1230 [Step 1 Type].
Bit 10 “Step 2” – sets polarity of the digital input for move step 2, P1240 [Step 2 Type].
Bit 11 “Step 3” – sets polarity of the digital input for move step 3, P1250 [Step 3 Type].
Bit 12 “Step 4” – sets polarity of the digital input for move step 4, P1260 [Step 4 Type].
APPLICATIONS
Bit 13 “Step 5” – sets polarity of the digital input for move step 5, P1270 [Step 5 Type].
Profiling
Bit 14 “Step 6” – sets polarity of the digital input for move step 6, P1280 [Step 6 Type].
Bit 15 “Step 7” – sets polarity of the digital input for move step 7, P1290 [Step 7 Type].
Bit 16 “Step 8” – sets polarity of the digital input for move step 8, P1300 [Step 8 Type].
Bit 17 “Step 9” – sets polarity of the digital input for move step 9, P1310 [Step 9 Type].
Bit 18 “Step 10” – sets polarity of the digital input for move step 10, P1320 [Step 10 Type].
Bit 19 “Step 11” – sets polarity of the digital input for move step 11, P1330 [Step 11 Type].
Bit 20 “Step 12” – sets polarity of the digital input for move step 12, P1340 [Step 12 Type].
Bit 21 “Step 13” – sets polarity of the digital input for move step 13, P1350 [Step 13 Type].
Bit 22 “Step 14” – sets polarity of the digital input for move step 14, P1360 [Step 14 Type].
Bit 23 “Step 15” – sets polarity of the digital input for move step 15, P1370 [Step 15 Type].
Bit 24 “Step 16” – sets polarity of the digital input for move step 16, P1380 [Step 16 Type].
1218 DI Hold Step Default: 0.00 RW 32-bit
Digital Input Hold Step Min/Max: 0.00 / 159999.15 Integer
Sets a digital input port for the hold step in profile/indexer control logic. The digital
input assigned by this parameter is equivalent to the hold step bit [P1173 Bit08].
Polarity of active state is defined by the hold step invert bit [P1177 Bit00].
1219 DI Abort Step Default: 0.00 RW 32-bit
Digital Input Abort Step Min/Max: 0.00 / 159999.15 Integer
Sets a digital input port for the abort step in profile/indexer control logic. Polarity
of active state is defined by the abort step invert bit [P1177 Bit01].
1220 DI Abort Profile Default: 0.00 RW 32-bit
Digital Input Abort Profile Min/Max: 0.00 / 159999.15 Integer
Sets a digital input port for the abort profile in profile/indexer control logic. Polarity
of active state is defined by the abort profile invert bit [P1177 Bit02].
1221 DI Vel Override Default: 0.00 RW 32-bit
Digital Input Velocity Profile Min/Max: 0.00 / 159999.15 Integer
Sets a digital input port for the velocity override in profile/indexer control logic.
The digital input assigned by this parameter is equivalent to the velocity override
bit [P1173 Bit09]. Polarity of active state is defined by the velocity override invert
bit [P1177 Bit03].
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
Cannot be used with most blended moves in Position Absolute type and Position
Profiling
Incremental type.
1233 Step 1 Decel Units: Secs RW Real
1243 Step 2 Decel Default: 10.00
1253 Step 3 Decel Min/Max: 0.00 / 3600.00
1263 Step 4 Decel
1273 Step 5 Decel
1283 Step 6 Decel
1293 Step 7 Decel
1303 Step 8 Decel
1313 Step 9 Decel
1323 Step 10 Decel
1333 Step 11 Decel
1343 Step 12 Decel
1353 Step 13 Decel
1363 Step 14 Decel
1373 Step 15 Decel
1383 Step 16 Decel
Step 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16 Deceleration
Set deceleration time between rated motor speed and zero in seconds. The
motor will decelerate towards zero speed. The minimum deceleration rate is
determined by the system inertia.
Cannot be used with most blended moves in Position Absolute type and Position
Incremental type.
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
most blended moves (exception dig-in blend), because most blended moves
Profiling
need to transition to the next step, instead of repeating. The dig-in blend moves
use this parameter to specify the number of digital input transitions required. A
zero step batch setting will cause that step to repeat forever.
1237 Step 1 Next Default: 2 RW 32-bit
1247 Step 2 Next Min/Max: 1 / 16 Integer
1257 Step 3 Next
1267 Step 4 Next
1277 Step 5 Next
1287 Step 6 Next
1297 Step 7 Next
1307 Step 8 Next
1317 Step 9 Next
1327 Step 10 Next
1337 Step 11 Next
1347 Step 12 Next
1357 Step 13 Next
1367 Step 14 Next
1377 Step 15 Next
1387 Step 16 Next
Step 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16 Next
Set step number that will be executed after the current step is complete. The
current step will be complete after any batch repeat cycles have finished.
Typically, steps are executed in ascending order, although this is not a
requirement. These parameters do not apply to a step having an End action,
since this step is normally used to terminate a sequence of step moves.
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
parameters is satisfied. The parameters for comparison are specified in the value
and dwell parameter.
Profiling
DigIn Blend (5) = DigIn Blend moves to the next step after the specified number
of digital input rising (or falling) edges are applied. The batch parameter specifies
the number of digital input edges.
Wait DigIn (6) = Wait DigIn moves to the next step after the digital input rising (or
falling) edges are applied.
1239 Step 1 Dig In Default: 0.00 RW 32-bit
1249 Step 2 Dig In Options: 0.00 / 159999.15 Integer
1259 Step 3 Dig In
1269 Step 4 Dig In
1279 Step 5 Dig In
1289 Step 6 Dig In
1299 Step 7 Dig In
1309 Step 8 Dig In
1319 Step 9 Dig In
1329 Step 10 Dig In
1339 Step 11 Dig In
1349 Step 12 Dig In
1359 Step 13 Dig In
1369 Step 14 Dig In
1379 Step 15 Dig In
1389 Step 16 Dig In
Step 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16 Digital Input
Set digital input sources. Not all steps use the digital input for the step move. The
following type and action moves use the dig-in parameters to specify the digital
input sources. Polarity (rising or falling edges) of digital input is set by the DI
invert parameter [P1177].
1. [Type] Position Absolute[Action] Wait DigIn
2. [Type] Position Incremental[Action] Wait DigIn
3. [Type] Speed Profile[Action] DigIn Blend
4. [Type] Speed Profile[Action] Wait DigIn
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
ReverseY Out
Options
Aux Cam En
Reref Psn In
ReverseX In
Unidirection
Cndtnl Hold
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Offset En
Alt Slope
Start
Default 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 = Disabled
Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 1 = Enabled
defined by the end point (P1405 [PCAM Main EndPnt] and P1439 [PCAM Aux
EndPnt]) at which point it is completed. If the x-axis then backs up into CAM
Camming
range, nothing happens; the profile has already completed and won't restart until
control Start (P1390 [PCAM Control]) is once again set.
“Continuous” (2) – At rising edge of Start (P1390 [PCAM Control]), the CAM
profile begins at point 0 and runs to the end point (P1405 [PCAM Main EndPnt]
and P1439 [PCAM Aux EndPnt]), and then repeats forever or until the control bit
Start (P1390 [PCAM Control]) is cleared.
“Persistent” (3) – At rising edge of Start (P1390 [PCAM Control]), the CAM profile
begins at point 0 and runs to the end point (P1405 [PCAM Main EndPnt] and
P1439 [PCAM Aux EndPnt]), and remains active until the control bit Start (P1390
[PCAM Control]) is cleared.
1392 PCAM Psn Select Default: 1393 RW 32-bit
Position Camming Position Select Options: 1 / 159999 Integer
The parameter selects a position reference source for x-axis.
1393 PCAM Psn Stpt Default: 0 RW 32-bit
Position Camming Position Setpoint Min/Max: –2147483648 / 2147483647 Integer
The parameter provides position reference for x-axis when the position reference
select (P1392 [PCAM Psn Select]) selects this parameter.
1394 PCAM Psn Ofst Default: 0 RW 32-bit
Position Camming Position Offset Min/Max: –2147483648 / 2147483647 Integer
The parameter provides position offset value to x-axis position when the offset
enable control bit (P1390 [PCAM Control]) is set. The offset value causes a
phase shift or position change in x-axis and a momentary change to CAM speed.
1395 PCAM PsnOfst Eps Default: 2000 RW 32-bit
Position Camming Position Offset Eps Min/Max: 0 / 2147483647 Integer
The parameter provides count of edges per second for virtual encoder function.
The value makes a limit on change of x-axis position in change of position offset
input.
1396 PCAM Span X Default: 8192 RW 32-bit
Position Camming Span X Min/Max: 0 / 2147483647 Integer
The parameter provides the number of integer counts equivalent to the span or
range of x-axis.
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
[PCAM VelScaleSel]) selects this parameter. The velocity scale multiplies the
Camming
velocity output (P1472 [PCAM Vel Out]) such that the velocity output (P1472) will
decrease if the velocity scale is less than 1.
1403 PCAM Slope Begin Default: 0.00 RW Real
Position Camming Slope Begin Min/Max: –214748000.00 / 214748000.00
The parameter provides beginning slope at CAM point 0. The parameter is used
only if the segment is cubic type curve.
1404 PCAM Slope End Default: 0.00 RW Real
Position Camming Slope End Min/Max: –214748000.00 / 214748000.00
The parameter provides ending slope at CAM point 0. The parameter is used
only if the segment is cubic type curve in both the main and the auxiliary CAM
profile.
1405 PCAM Main EndPnt Default: 0 RW 32-bit
Position Camming Main End Point Options: 1 / 15 Integer
The parameter provides a number of the last CAM point used in the main CAM
profile.
1406 PCAM Main Types
Position Camming Main Types
Each bit sets curve type for each segment in the main CAM profile. If the bit is clear, the curve is linear at the point of segment in the main CAM
profile. If the bit is set, the curve is cubic at the point of segment in the main CAM profile.
CubicCurve15
CubicCurve14
CubicCurve13
CubicCurve12
CubicCurve11
CubicCurve10
Options
CubicCurve9
CubicCurve8
CubicCurve7
CubicCurve6
CubicCurve5
CubicCurve4
CubicCurve3
CubicCurve2
CubicCurve1
CubicCurve0
Default 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 = Disabled
Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 1 = Enabled
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
Provides y-coordinate value for CAM point in the main CAM profile.
1439 PCAM Aux EndPnt Default: 0 RW 32-bit
Position Camming Auxiliary End Point Options: 1 / 15 Integer
Provides a number of the last CAM point used in the auxiliary CAM profile.
1440 PCAM Aux Types
Position Camming Auxiliary Types
Each bit sets curve type for each segment in the auxiliary CAM profile. If the bit is clear, the curve is linear at the point of segment in the auxiliary
CAM profile. If the bit is set, the curve is cubic at the point of segment in the auxiliary CAM profile.
CubicCurve15
CubicCurve14
CubicCurve13
CubicCurve12
CubicCurve11
CubicCurve10
Options
CubicCurve9
CubicCurve8
CubicCurve7
CubicCurve6
CubicCurve5
CubicCurve4
CubicCurve3
CubicCurve2
CubicCurve1
Reserved
Default 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 = Disabled
Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 1 = Enabled
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
Contins Mode
Options
Persist Mode
Aux Cam En
Single Mode
Reref Pos In
ReverseX In
Unidirection
Cndtnl Hold
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Offset En
Alt Slope
In Cam
Start
Default 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 = Disabled
APPLICATIONS
Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 1 = Enabled
Camming
Drive Parameter Param Name Text Parameter # Param Name Text Parameter #
Cross Reference By Brake Off Adj 1 402 DB Resistor Type 382
Brake Off Adj 2 403 DC Brake Ki 396
Name Brk Set Time 1108 DC Brake Kp 397
Brk Slip Count 1110 DC Brake Level 394
Param Name Text Parameter #
Break Frequency 63 DC Brake Lvl Sel 393
Accel Time 1 535
Break Voltage 62 DC Brake Time 395
Accel Time 2 536
Brk Alarm Travel 1109 DC Brk Vd Fltr 399
Access Level 301
Brk Release Time 1107 DC Brk Vq Fltr 398
Active Cur Lmt 424
Bus Limit ACR Ki 378 DC Bus Mem Reset 464
Active Vel Fdbk 131
Bus Limit ACR Kp 379 DC Bus Memory 12
Actual Home Psn 737
Bus Limit Kd 377 DC Bus Volts 11
Actv SpTqPs Mode 313
Bus Limit Kp 376 Dec Inhibit Actn 409
Adj Vltg AccTime 1149
Bus Reg Ki 380 Decel Time 1 537
Adj Vltg Command 1148
Bus Reg Kp 381 Decel Time 2 538
Adj Vltg DecTime 1150
Bus Reg Level 375 Delayed Spd Ref 139
Adj Vltg MaxVltg 1162
Bus Reg Lvl Cnfg 374 DI Abort Profile 1220
Adj Vltg Phase 1145
Bus Reg Mode A 372 DI Abort Step 1219
Adj Vltg Preset1 1151
Bus Reg Mode B 373 DI Accel 2 179
Adj Vltg Preset2 1152
Bus Utilization 42 DI Aux Fault 157
Adj Vltg Preset3 1153
Clear Flt Owner 923 DI BusReg Mode B 186
Adj Vltg Preset4 1154
Cntl Sts Tp Data 989 DI Clear Fault 156
Adj Vltg Preset5 1155
Cntl Sts Tp Sel 988 DI Coast Stop 160
Adj Vltg Preset6 1156
Commanded SpdRef 2 DI Cur Lmt Stop 159
Adj Vltg Preset7 1157
Commanded Trq 4 DI Decel 2 180
Adj Vltg RefMult 1158
Condition Sts 1 937 DI Enable 155
Adj Vltg S Curve 1159
Control TP Data 987 DI Find Home 732
Adj Vltg Select 1146
Control TP Sel 986 DI FloatMicroPsn 1102
Adj Vltg Trim % 1160
Counts Per Unit 1215 DI Fwd Dec Limit 197
Adj Vltg TrimSel 1147
Current Limit 1 422 DI Fwd End Limit 196
Alarm Status A 959
Current Limit 2 423 DI Fwd Reverse 162
Alarm Status B 960
Current Limit Kd 428 DI Hold Step 1218
AlarmA at Fault 962
Current Limit Ki 429 DI Indx Step 772
AlarmB at Fault 963
Current Limit Kp 430 DI Indx StepPrst 774
Alt Man Ref AnHi 329
Current Lmt Sel 421 DI Indx StepRev 773
Alt Man Ref AnLo 330
Current Rate Lmt 425 DI Jog 1 166
Alt Man Ref Sel 328
Data In A1 895 DI Jog 1 Forward 167
Alt Speed Reg BW 648
Data In A2 896 DI Jog 1 Reverse 168
Alt Speed Reg Ki 650
Data In B1 897 DI Jog 2 169
Alt Speed Reg Kp 649
Data In B2 898 DI Jog 2 Forward 170
Alt Vel Fdbk Sel 128
Data In C1 899 DI Jog 2 Reverse 171
Alt Vel FdbkFltr 129
Data In C2 900 DI ManRef Sel 563
Alt Vel Feedback 130
Data In D1 901 DI ManRef AnlgHi 564
AltSpdErr FltrBW 651
Data In D2 902 DI ManRef AnlgLo 565
Ampl Detect Sel 1172
Data Out A1 905 DI Manual Ctrl 172
At Limit Status 945
Data Out A2 906 DI MOP Dec 178
Auto Mask 325
Data Out B1 907 DI MOP Inc 177
Auto Retry Fault 347
Data Out B2 908 DI NHdwr OvrTrvl 201
Auto Rstrt Delay 349
Data Out C1 909 DI OL Home Limit 734
Auto Rstrt Tries 348
Data Out C2 910 DI PHdwr OvrTrvl 200
Autotune 70
Data Out D1 911 DI PID Enable 191
Autotune Speed 72
Data Out D2 912 DI PID Hold 192
Autotune Torque 71
DB Ext Ohms 383 DI PID Invert 194
Aux Vel Fdbk Sel 132
DB Ext Watts 384 DI PID Reset 193
Aux Vel FdbkFltr 133
DB ExtPulseWatts 385 DI Prchrg Seal 190
Aux Vel Feedback 134
Param Name Text Parameter # Param Name Text Parameter # Param Name Text Parameter #
DI Precharge 189 Fault Status A 952 Inertia Acc Gain 696
DI Pwr Loss 188 Fault Status B 953 Inertia Adapt BW 705
DI PwrLoss ModeB 187 Filtered Spd Ref 595 Inertia Comp Out 699
DI Redefine Psn 733 Filtered SpdFdbk 640 Inertia Dec Gain 697
DI Rev Dec Limit 199 Filtered Trq Ref 689 Inertia Test Lmt 77
DI Rev End Limit 198 Final Speed Ref 597 InertiaAdaptGain 706
DI Run 163 Find Home Ramp 736 Inertia CompMode 695
DI Run Forward 164 Find Home Speed 735 InertiaTrqAdd 708
DI Run Reverse 165 Float Tolerance 1111 InFan Derate 495
DI Speed Sel 0 173 Flux Braking En 388 InFan ElpsdLife 497
DI Speed Sel 1 174 Flux Braking Ki 390 InFan EventActn 500
DI Speed Sel 2 175 Flux Braking Kp 391 InFan EventLevel 499
DI SpTqPs Sel 0 181 Flux Braking Lmt 389 InFan RemainLife 498
DI SpTqPs Sel 1 182 Flux Cur Fdbk 6 InFan ResetLog 501
DI Start 161 Flux Current Ref 75 InFan TotalLife 496
DI Stop 158 Flux Down Ki 45 InPhase LossActn 462
DI Stop Mode B 185 Flux Down Kp 46 In Pos Psn Band 726
DI StrtStep Sel0 1222 Flux Reg Enable 103 In Pos Psn Dwell 727
DI StrtStep Sel1 1223 Flux Reg Ki 104 Interp Acc Out 761
DI StrtStep Sel2 1224 Flux Reg Kp 105 Interp Control 755
DI StrtStep Sel3 1225 Flux Up Enable 43 Interp DeltaTime 758
DI StrtStep Sel4 1226 Flux Up Time 44 Interp Psn Input 756
DI Torque StptA 195 FlyingStart Mode 356 Interp Psn Out 759
DI Vel Override 1221 FS Excitation Ki 361 Interp Vel Input 757
Digital In Conf 150 FS Excitation Kp 362 Interp Vel Out 760
Digital In Sts 220 FS Gain 357 Iq Lo FreqCur Kp 432
Dir Owner 922 FS Ki 358 IR Voltage Drop 73
Direction Mode 308 FS Msrmnt CurLvl 364 Ixo Voltage Drop 74
Drive Checksum 344 FS Reconnect Dly 363 Jerk Gain 433
Drive Logic Rslt 879 FS Speed Reg Ki 359 Jog Acc Dec Time 539
Drive OL Count 940 FS Speed Reg Kp 360 Jog Owner 921
Drive OL Mode 420 Gearbox Limit 1134 Jog Speed 1 556
DPI Logic Rslt 882 Gearbox Rating 1135 Jog Speed 2 557
Drive Ramp Rslt 881 Gearbox Ratio 1136 Language 302
Drive Ref Rslt 880 Gearbox Sheave 1137 Last Fault Code 951
Drive Status 1 935 Ground Warn Lvl 467 Last StartSource 931
Drive Status 2 936 Ground Warn Actn 466 Last Stop Source 932
Drive Temp C 944 Homing Control 731 Last StrtInhibit 934
Drive Temp Pct 943 Homing Status 730 LdPsn Fdbk Div 826
Droop RPM @ FLA 620 HSFan Derate 488 LdPsn Fdbk Mult 825
Duty Rating 306 HSFan ElpsdLife 490 Limited Spd Ref 593
Econ AccDec Ki 48 HSFan EventActn 493 Limited Trq Ref 690
Econ AccDec Kp 49 HSFan EventLevel 492 Load Estimate 707
Econ At Ref Ki 47 HSFan RemainLife 491 Load Loss Action 441
Elapsed kWH 14 HSFan ResetLog 494 Load Loss Level 442
Elapsed MWH 13 HSFan TotalLife 489 Load Loss Time 443
Encdrlss AngComp 78 IA LdObs Delay 709 Load Observer BW 711
Encdrlss VltComp 79 Id Lo FreqCur Kp 431 Load Psn FdbkSel 136
Ext Ramped Ref 700 IGBT Temp C 942 Logic Mask 324
Fast Braking Ki 400 IGBT Temp Pct 941 Logic Mask Act 886
Fast Braking Kp 401 InPhase Loss Lvl 463 Manual Cmd Mask 326
Fault Amps 957 InAdp LdObs Mode 704 Manual Owner 924
Fault Bus Volts 958 Inert Comp LPFBW 698 Manual Preload 331
Fault Frequency 956 InertAdptFltrBW 710 Manual Ref Mask 327
Param Name Text Parameter # Param Name Text Parameter # Param Name Text Parameter #
Max Fwd Speed 520 MtrLubeEventLvl 509 PID FBLoss SpSel 1075
Max Rev Speed 521 MtrOL Reset Time 416 PID FBLoss TqSel 1076
Max Rod Speed 1127 Neg Torque Limit 671 PID Fdbk Meter 1091
Max Rod Torque 1128 Notch Fltr Atten 688 PID Fdbk AnlgHi 1073
Maximum Freq 37 Notch Fltr Freq 687 PID Fdbk AnlgLo 1074
Maximum Voltage 36 OilWellPump Cnfg 1131 PID Fdbk Mult 1078
MchBrngElpsdLife 512 Open Loop Fdbk 137 PID Fdbk 1077
MchBrngEventActn 515 Out PhaseLossLvl 445 PID Fdbk Sel 1072
MchBrngEventLvl 514 OutPhaseLossActn 444 PID Int Time 1087
MchBrngRemainLif 513 Output Current 7 PID Lower Limit 1082
MchBrngResetLog 516 Output Frequency 1 PID LP Filter BW 1084
MchBrngTotalLife 511 Output Power 9 PID Output Meter 1093
MchLube ElpsdHrs 517 Output Powr Fctr 10 PID Output Mult 1080
MchLube EventLvl 518 Output Voltage 8 PID Output Sel 1079
MchLubeEventActn 519 Overspeed Limit 524 PID Preload 1085
MicroPsnScalePct 1112 PCAM Aux EndPnt 1439 PID Prop Gain 1086
Min Adj Voltage 1161 PCAM Aux Pt X 1…15 1441…1469 PID Ref AnlgHi 1068
Min Fwd Speed 522 PCAM Aux Pt Y 1…15 1442…1470 PID Ref AnlgLo 1069
Min Rev Speed 523 PCAM Aux Types 1440 PID Ref Meter 1090
Min Rod Speed 1129 PCAM Control 1390 PID Ref Mult 1071
Minor Flt Cfg 950 PCAM Main EndPnt 1405 PID Ref Sel 1067
MOP High Limit 561 PCAM Main Pt X 0…15 1407…1437 PID Setpoint 1070
MOP Low Limit 562 PCAM Main Pt Y 0…15 1408…1438 PID Status 1089
MOP Rate 560 PCAM Mode 1391 PID Upper Limit 1081
MOP Reference 558 PCAM Psn Ofst 1394 PkDtct Stpt Dint 1036
Motor Ctrl Mode 35 PCAM Psn Out 1473 PkDtct Stpt Real 1035
Motor NP Amps 26 PCAM Psn Select 1392 PkDtct1 In Sel 1037
Motor NP Hertz 27 PCAM Psn Stpt 1393 PkDtct1PresetSel 1038
Motor NP Power 30 PCAM PsnOfst Eps 1395 PkDtct2 In Sel 1042
Motor NP RPM 28 PCAM Scale X 1397 PkDtct2PresetSel 1043
Motor NP Volts 25 PCAM ScaleY Sel 1399 PLL BW 801
Motor OL Actn 410 PCAM ScaleYSetPt 1400 PLL Control 795
Motor Poles 31 PCAM Slope Begin 1403 PLL Enc Out 809
Motor Power Lmt 427 PCAM Slope End 1404 PLL Enc Out Adv 810
Motor Sheave 1130 PCAM Span X 1396 PLL EPR Input 804
Mtr NP Pwr Units 29 PCAM Span Y 1398 PLL EPR Output 811
Mtr OL Alarm Lvl 412 PCAM Status 1471 PLL Ext Spd Sel 796
Mtr OL at Pwr Up 411 PCAM Vel Out PLL Ext Spd Stpt 797
Mtr OL Counts 418 PCAM VelScaleSel 1401 PLL Ext SpdScale 798
Mtr OL Factor 413 PCAM VelScaleSP 1402 PLL LPFilter BW 802
Mtr OL Hertz 414 PCP Pump Sheave 1132 PLL Psn Out Fltr 806
Mtr OL Reset Lvl 415 PCP Rod Torque 1133 PLL Psn Ref Sel 799
Mtr OL Trip Time 419 Peak 1 Change 1040 PLL Psn Stpt 800
Mtr Options Cnfg 40 Peak 2 Change 1045 PLL Rvls Input 805
Mtr Psn Fdbk Sel 135 Peak1 Cfg 1039 PLL Rvls Output 812
Mtr Vel Fdbk 3 Peak2 Cfg 1044 PLL Speed Out 807
MtrBrng ResetLog 507 PeakDetect1 Out 1041 PLL Speed OutAdv 808
MtrBrngElpsdLife 503 PeakDetect2 Out 1046 PLL Virt Enc RPM 803
MtrBrngEventActn 506 Phase Delay Comp 108 PM Alt Enc Offset 82
MtrBrngEventLev 505 PID Cfg 1065 PM CEMF Voltage 86
MtrBrngRemainLif 504 PID Control 1066 PM Cfg 80
MtrBrngTotalLife 502 PID Deadband 1083 PM Dir Test Cur 93
MtrLubeElpsdHrs 508 PID Deriv Time 1088 PM IR Voltage 87
MtrLubeEventActn 510 PID Error Meter 1092 PM IXd Voltage 89
Param Name Text Parameter # Param Name Text Parameter # Param Name Text Parameter #
PM IXq Voltage 88 Psn EGR Div 817 PwrLoss RT BusKd 457
PM OfsTst Cur 83 Psn EGR Mult 816 PwrLoss RT BusKp 456
PM OfstTst CRamp 84 Psn Load Actual 837 Ramped Spd Ref 594
PM OfstTst FRamp 85 Psn Offset 1 821 Rated Amps 21
PM PriEnc Offset 81 Psn Offset 1 Sel 820 Rated kW 22
PM Vqs Reg Ki 92 Psn Offset 2 823 Rated Volts 20
PM Vqs Reg Kp 91 Psn Offset 2 Sel 822 Ref Select Owner 925
Port 1 Reference 871 Psn Offset Vel 824 Regen Power Lmt 426
Port 2 Reference 872 Psn Out Fltr BW 834 Reset Meters 336
Port 3 Reference 873 Psn Out Fltr Sel 832 Run Boost 61
Port 4 Reference 874 Psn Out FltrGain 833 S Curve Accel 540
Port 5 Reference 875 Psn Ref EGR Out 815 S Curve Decel 541
Port 6 Reference 876 Psn Reg Droop 846 Save MOP Ref 559
Port Mask Act 885 Psn Reg Ki 838 Selected Spd Ref 592
Port13 Reference 877 Psn Reg Kp 839 Selected Trq Ref 685
Port14 Reference 878 Psn Reg Status 724 Servo Lock Gain 642
Pos Torque Limit 670 Psn Selected Ref 722 SFAdapt CnvrgLmt 116
Psn Actual 836 PsnNtchFltrDepth 831 SFAdapt CnvrgLvl 115
Position Control 721 PsnNtchFltrFreq 830 SFAdapt SlewLmt 113
Psn Error 835 Psn Ref Select 765 SFAdapt SlewRate 114
Psn Fdbk 847 PsnReg IntgrlOut 842 Shear Pin 1 Actn 435
Power Loss Actn 449 PsnReg Spd Out 843 Shear Pin 1 Time 437
PowerUp Delay 346 PsnWatch1 DtctIn 746 Shear Pin 2 Actn 438
PredMaint Rst En 471 PsnWatch1 Select 745 Shear Pin 2 Time 440
Prchrg Control 321 PsnWatch1 Stpt 747 Shear Pin Cfg 434
Prchrg Delay 322 PsnWatch2 DtctIn 749 Shear Pin1 Level 436
Prchrg Err Cfg 323 PsnWatch2 Select 748 Shear Pin2 Level 439
PredMaint Reset 472 PsnWatch2 Stpt 750 Simulator Fdbk 138
PredMaintAmbTemp 470 PTP Accel Time 781 Skip Speed 1 526
PredMaintManSave 477 PTP Command 784 Skip Speed 2 527
PredMaintRTCHour 474 PTP Control 770 Skip Speed 3 528
PredMaintRTCMin 475 PTP Decel Time 782 Skip Speed Band 529
PredMaintStorage 473 PTP Feedback 777 SLAT Dwell Time 315
PReg Neg Int Lmt 841 PTP Fwd Vel Lmt 785 SLAT Err Stpt 314
PReg Neg Spd Lmt 845 PTP Index Preset 779 Sleep Level 352
PReg Pos Int Lmt 840 PTP Mode 771 Sleep Time 353
PReg Pos Spd Lmt 844 PTP PsnRefStatus 720 Sleep Wake Mode 350
Preset Speed 1 571 PTP Ref Scale 778 SleepWake RefSel 351
Preset Speed 2 572 PTP Ref Sel 775 Slip Adapt Iqs 112
Preset Speed 3 573 PTP Reference 776 Slip Comp BW 622
Preset Speed 4 574 PTP Rev Vel Lmt 786 Slip Reg Enable 100
Preset Speed 5 575 PTP S Curve 787 Slip Reg Ki 101
Preset Speed 6 576 PTP Setpoint 780 Slip Reg Kp 102
Preset Speed 7 577 PTP Speed FwdRef 783 Slip RPM @ FLA 621
Pri Vel Fdbk Sel 125 PTP Vel Override 788 Spd Err Filt BW 644
Pri Vel FdbkFltr 126 PWM Frequency 38 Spd Loop Damping 653
Pri Vel Feedback 127 Pwr Loss A Level 451 Spd Options Ctrl 635
Prof DI Invert 1217 Pwr Loss A Time 452 Spd Ref A AnlgHi 547
Profile Command 1213 Pwr Loss B Level 454 Spd Ref A AnlgLo 548
Profile Status 1210 Pwr Loss B Time 455 Spd Ref A Stpt 546
ProfVel Override 1216 Pwr Loss Mode A 450 Spd Ref B AnlgHi 552
Psn Command 723 Pwr Loss Mode B 453 Spd Ref B AnlgLo 553
Psn Direct Ref 767 PwrLoss RT AcrKi 459 Spd Ref B Stpt 551
Psn Direct Stpt 766 PwrLoss RT AcrKp 458 Spd Ref Filter 588
Param Name Text Parameter # Param Name Text Parameter # Param Name Text Parameter #
Spd Ref Fltr BW 589 Step 1…16 Next 1237…1387 Torque Cur Fdbk 5
Spd Ref FltrGain 590 Step 1…16 Type 1230…1380 Trq Ref A Sel 675
Spd Ref Sel Sts 591 Step 1…16 Value 1234…1384 Trq Ref B Sel 680
Spd Reg Int Out 654 Step 1…16 Velocity 1231…1381 Torque Step 686
Speed Reg Max Kp 646 Stop Mode A 370 Total Gear Ratio 1126
Spd Reg Neg Lmt 656 Stop Mode B 371 Total Inertia 76
SReg Output 660 Stop Owner 919 Trim Ref A Sel 600
Spd Reg Pos Lmt 655 SVC Boost Filter 64 Trim Ref A Stpt 601
Spd Trim Source 617 Sweep Autotune 1165 Trim Ref B Sel 604
SpdBand Intgrtr 1106 Sweep Freq Detec 1170 Trim Ref B Stpt 605
SpdReg AntiBckup 643 Sweep Freq Max 1169 Trim RefA AnlgHi 602
SpdTrimPrcRefSrc 616 Sweep Freq Min 1168 Trim RefA AnlgLo 603
SpdTrqPsn Mode A 309 Sweep Time 1171 Trim RefB AnlgHi 606
SpdTrqPsn Mode B 310 Sweep Volt Max 1167 Trim RefB AnlgLo 607
SpdTrqPsn Mode C 311 Sweep Volt Min 1166 TrmPct RefA Sel 608
SpdTrqPsn Mode D 312 Testpoint Bval 1 973 TrmPct RefB Sel 612
Speed Comp Gain 666 Testpoint Bval 2 977 TrmPct RefA AnHi 610
Speed Comp Out 667 Testpoint Bval 3 981 TrmPct RefA AnLo 611
Speed Comp Sel 665 Testpoint Bval 4 985 TrmPct RefA Stpt 609
Speed Dev Band 1105 Testpoint Fval 1 971 TrmPct RefB AnHi 614
Speed Error 641 Testpoint Fval 2 975 TrmPct RefB AnLo 615
Speed Rate Ref 596 Testpoint Fval 3 979 TrmPct RefB Stpt 613
Spd Ref A Mult 549 Testpoint Fval 4 983 Type 2 Alarm 961
Spd Ref A Sel 545 Testpoint Lval 1 972 UnderVltg Action 460
Spd Ref B Mult 554 Testpoint Lval 2 976 UnderVltg Level 461
Spd Ref B Sel 550 Testpoint Lval 3 980 Units Traveled 1212
Spd Ref Scale 555 Testpoint Lval 4 984 User Home Psn 738
Speed Ref Source 930 Testpoint Sel 1 970 VCL Cur Reg BW 95
Speed Reg BW 636 Testpoint Sel 2 974 VCL Cur Reg Ki 97
Speed Reg Ki 647 Testpoint Sel 3 978 VCL Cur Reg Kp 96
Speed Reg Kp 645 Testpoint Sel 4 982 VEncdls FReg Ki 99
Speed Units 300 Trq Adapt En 107 VEncdls FReg Kp 98
SReg FB Fltr BW 639 Trq Adapt Speed 106 VHz Curve 65
SReg FB Fltr Sel 637 Trq Comp Mtring 110 VHzSV Spd Reg Ki 664
SReg FB FltrGain 638 Trq Comp Regen 111 VHzSV Spd Reg Kp 663
SReg OutFltr BW 659 Trq Ref A Mult 679 VHzSV SpdTrimReg 623
SReg OutFltr Sel 657 Trq Ref A Stpt 676 Virtual Enc EPR 141
SReg OutFltrGain 658 Trq Ref B Mult 684 Virtual Enc Psn 142
SReg Trq Preset 652 Trq Ref B Stpt 681 Virtual EncDelay 140
Stab Angle Gain 52 Trq Ref A AnlgHi 677 Voltage Class 305
Stab Volt Gain 51 Trq Ref A AnlgLo 678 Wake Level 354
Stability Filter 50 Trq Ref B AnlgHi 682 Wake Time 355
Start At PowerUp 345 Trq Ref B AnlgLo 683 Write Mask Act 887
Start Inhibits 933 TorqAlarm Action 1120 Write Mask Cfg 888
Start Owner 920 TorqAlarm Config 1121 Xhrs after PwrUp
Start/Acc Boost 60 TorqAlarm Dwell 1122 Zero Position 725
Status1 at Fault 954 TorqAlarm Level 1123 Zero Speed Limit 525
Status2 at Fault 955 TorqAlarm TOActn 1125 ZeroSpdFloatTime 1113
Step 1…16 Accel 1232…1382 TorqAlm Timeout 1124
Step 1…16 Action 1238…1388 Trq Lmt SlewRate 1104
Step 1…16 Batch 1236…1386 Trq Prove Cfg 1100
Step 1…16 Decel 1233…1383 Trq Prove Setup 1101
Step 1…16 Dig In 1239…1389 Trq Prove Status 1103
Step 1…16 Dwell 1235…1385 Trq Comp Mode 109
I/O Module
Parameters
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
Input 5
Input 4
Input 3
Input 2
Input 1
Input 0
Default 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 = Input Not Activated
Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 1 = Input Activated
Options
Input 5
Input 4
Input 3
Input 2
Input 1
Input 0
Default 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 1 1 0 = Input Not Filtered
Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 1 = Input Filtered
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
Relay Out 0
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Default 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 = Output De-energized
Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 1 = Output Energized
Relay Out 0
Trans Out 0
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
(1) Bit 1
= “Trans Out 0” for I/O Module model 20-750-2263C-1R2T
= “Relay Out 1” for I/O Module models 20-750-2262C-2R and 20-750-2262D-2R
(2) Bit 2 is only used by I/O Module 20-750-2263C-1R2T
Options
Relay Out 0
Trans Out 0
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
(1)
Bit 1 = “Trans Out 0” for I/O Module model 20-750-2263C-1R2T
= “Relay Out 1” for I/O Module models 20-750-2262C-2R and 20-750-2262D-2R
(2)
Bit 2 is only used by I/O Module 20-750-2263C-1R2T
10 RO0 Sel Default: 0.00 (Disabled) RW 32-bit
Relay Output 0 Select Min/Max: 0.00 / 159999.15 Integer
Selects the source that will energize the relay output.
11 RO0 Level Sel Default: 0 (Disabled) RW 32-bit
Relay Output 0 Level Select Min/Max: 0 / 159999 Integer
Selects the source of the level that will be compared.
12 RO0 Level Default: 0.0 RW Real
Relay Output 0 Level Min/Max: –/+1000000.0
Sets the level compare value.
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
Less Than
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Default 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 = Condition False
Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 1 = Condition True
Bit 0 “Less Than” – Level source is less than the level value.
Bit 1 “Grt Than Equ” – Level source is greater than or equal to the level value.
14 RO0 On Time Units: Secs RW Real
Relay Output 0 On Time Default: 0.0
Sets the “ON Delay” time for the digital outputs. This is the time between the Min/Max: 0.0 / 600.0
occurrence of a condition and activation of the relay.
15 RO0 Off Time Units: Secs RW Real
Relay Output 0 Off Time Default: 0.0
Sets the “OFF Delay” time for the digital outputs. This is the time between the Min/Max: 0.0 / 600.0
disappearance of a condition and de-activation of the relay.
20 RO1 Sel Default: 0 (Disabled) RW 32-bit
Relay Output 1 Select – I/O Module model 20-750-2262C-2R or Min/Max: 0 / 15999915 Integer
20-750-2262D-2R is installed.
TO0 Sel
HOST GROUPS
Digital Outputs
Options
Less Than
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Bit 0 “Less Than” – Level source is less than the level value.
Bit 1 “Grt Than Equ” – Level source is greater than or equal to the level value.
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
Options
Less Than
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Bit 0 “Less Than” – Level source is less than the level value.
Bit 1 “Grt Than Equ” – Level source is greater than or equal to the level value.
Important: Only used by I/O Module model 20-750-2263C-1R2T.
34 TO1 On Time Units: Secs RW Real
Transistor Output 1 On Time Default: 0.0
Sets the “ON Delay” time for the digital outputs. This is the time between the Min/Max: 0.0 / 600.0
occurrence of a condition and activation of the transistor.
Important: Only used by I/O Module model 20-750-2263C-1R2T.
35 TO1 Off Time Units: Secs RW Real
Transistor Output 1 Off Time Default: 0.0
Sets the “OFF Delay” time for the digital outputs. This is the time between the Min/Max: 0.0 / 600.0
disappearance of a condition and de-activation of the transistor.
Important: Only used by I/O Module model 20-750-2263C-1R2T.
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
Over Temp
Options
PTC Short
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
PTC Ok
Default 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 = Condition False
Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 1 = Condition True
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
Options
Analog 1
Analog 0
46 Anlg In Sqrt
Analog Input Square Root
Enables/disables the square root function for each input.
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Options
Analog 1
Analog 0
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Options
Loss 1
Loss 0
Loss
Default 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 = Loss not Present
Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 1 = Loss Present
0.000 mA
Min/Max: –/+10.000 Volts
0.000 / 20.000 mA
52 Anlg In0 Lo Units: Volts RW Real
Analog Input 0 Low mA
Sets the lowest input value to the analog input scaling block. Default: 0.000 Volts
0.000 mA
Min/Max: –/+10.000 Volts
0.000 / 20.000 mA
53 Anlg In0 LssActn Default: 0 = “Ignore” RW 32-bit
Analog Input 0 Loss Action Options: 0 = “Ignore” Integer
Selects drive action when an analog signal loss is detected. Signal loss is defined 1 = “Alarm”
as an analog signal less than 1V or 2mA. The signal loss event ends and normal 2 = “Flt Minor“
operation resumes when the input signal level is greater than or equal to 1.5V or 3 = “FltCoastStop“
3mA. 4 = “Flt RampStop“
“Ignore” (0) – No action is taken 5 = “Flt CL Stop“
“Alarm” (1) – Alarm occurs 6 = “Hold Input”
“Flt Minor“ (2) – Minor Fault occurs if enabled, otherwise Fault Coast Stop 7 = “Set Input Lo”
“FltCoastStop“ (3) – Fault Coast Stop occurs 8 = “Set Input Hi”
“Flt RampStop“ (4) – Fault Ramp Stop occurs
“Flt CL Stop“ (5) – Fault Current Limit Stop occurs
“Hold Input” (6) – Holds input at last value
“Set Input Lo” (7) – Sets input to P52 [Anlg In0 Lo]
“Set Input Hi” (8) – Sets input to P51 [Anlg In0 Hi]
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
Sets the lowest input value to the analog input scaling block.
Analog Inputs
0.000 mA
Min/Max: –/+10.000 Volts
0.000 / 20.000 mA
63 Anlg In1 LssActn Default: 0 = “Ignore” RW 32-bit
Analog Input 1 Loss Action Options: 0 = “Ignore” Integer
Selects drive action when an analog signal loss is detected. Signal loss is defined 1 = “Alarm”
as an analog signal less than 1V or 2mA. The signal loss event ends and normal 2 = “Flt Minor”
operation resumes when the input signal level is greater than or equal to 1.5V or 3 = “FltCoastStop”
3mA. 4 = “Flt RampStop”
“Ignore” (0) – No action is taken 5 = “Flt CL Stop”
“Alarm” (1) – Alarm occurs 6 = “Hold Input”
“Flt Minor“ (2) – Minor Fault occurs if enabled, otherwise Fault Coast Stop 7 = “Set Input Lo”
“FltCoastStop“ (3) – Fault Coast Stop occurs 8 = “Set Input Hi”
“Flt RampStop“ (4) – Fault Ramp Stop occurs
“Flt CL Stop“ (5) – Fault Current Limit Stop occurs
“Hold Input” (6) – Holds input at last value
“Set Input Lo” (7) – Sets input to P62 [Anlg In1 Lo]
“Set Input Hi” (8) – Sets input to P61 [Anlg In1 Hi]
64 Anlg In1 Raw Val Units: Volts RO Real
Analog Input 1 Raw Value mA
Raw Value of the analog input. Default: 0.000 Volts
0.000 mA
Min/Max: –/+10.000 Volts
0.000 / 20.000 mA
65 Anlg In1 Filt Gn Default: 1.00 RW Real
Analog Input 1 Filter Gain Min/Max: –/+5.00
Sets the analog input filter gain.
66 Anlg In1 Filt BW Default: 0.0 RW Real
Analog Input 1 Filter Bandwidth Min/Max: 0.0 / 500.0
Sets the analog input filter bandwidth.
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
Analog 1
Analog 0
Default 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 = Voltage Mode
Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 1 = Current Mode
Analog 1
Analog 0
Default 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 1 0 = Condition False
Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 1 = Condition True
A possible source for an analog output. Can be used to control an analog output Min/Max: –10/20
from a communication device using a DataLink.
77 Anlg Out0 Data Default: 0 RO Real
Analog Output 0 Data Min/Max: –/+100000
Displays the value of the source selected by P75 [Anlg Out0 Sel].
78 Anlg Out0 DataHi Default: 1 RW Real
Analog Output 0 Data High Min/Max: –/+214748000
Sets the high value for the data range of analog out scale.
79 Anlg Out0 DataLo Default: 1 RW Real
Analog Output 0 Data Low Min/Max: –/+214748000
Sets the low value for the data range of analog out scale.
80 Anlg Out0 Hi Units: Volts RW Real
Analog Output 0 High mA
Sets the high value for the analog output value when the data value is at its Default: 10.000 Volts
maximum. 20.000 mA
Min/Max: –/+10.000 Volts
0.000 / 20.000 mA
81 Anlg Out0 Lo Units: Volts RW Real
Analog Output 0 Low mA
Sets the low value for the analog output value when the data value is at its Default: 0.000 Volts
minimum. 0.000 mA
Min/Max: –/+10.000 Volts
0.000 / 20.000 mA
82 Anlg Out0 Val Units: Volts RO Real
Analog Output 0 Value mA
Displays the analog output value. Default: 10.000 Volts
20.000 mA
Min/Max: –/+10.000 Volts
0.000 / 20.000 mA
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
Relay Out 0
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Master
(1)
Bit 1 = “Relay Out 0” for I/O Module models 20-750-2262C-2R and 20-750-2262D-2R
100 RO0 Load Type Default: 1 = “DC Inductive” RW 32-bit
Relay Output 0 Load Type Options: 0 = “DC Resistive” Integer
Sets the type of load that will be applied to the relay. Must be properly set for the 1 = “DC Inductive”
Predictive Maintenance function to predict the relay life. 2 = “AC Resistive“
3 = “AC Inductive“
101 RO0 Load Amps Units: Amps RW Real
HOST GROUPS
Predictive Main
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
Single Incremental
Encoder Module
Parameters
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
Single Ended
Options
A Chan Only
Z Chan Enbl
Inv Home In
Edge Mode
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Direction
Default 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 = Condition False
Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 1 = Condition True
Bit 0 “Z Channel Enbl” – Configures the Channel Z to be used and monitored for Phase Loss. A value of 0 = the Z channel will be ignored.
Bit 1 “A Chan Only” – Configures the module to use only the A channel, and ignore the B channel. In this mode, direction cannot be determined, and
the position counter will always count up.
HOST GROUPS
Bit 2 “Edge Mode” – Configure the module to use AB edge time data for speed calculation rather than accumulated count.
Bit 3 “Inv Home In” – Configures the home input to be inverted. 1 = inverted, 0 = not inverted
Bit 4 “Single Ended” – Configure when the A Quad B encoder has single ended signals. In this mode, Phase Loss detection is disabled. 0 =
Differential, 1 = Single Ended
Bit 5 “Direction” – Inverts the position count up/down associated with a given rotation direction internally. 1 = invert, 0 = do not invert
2 Encoder PPR Default: 1024 RW Real
Encoder Pulses Per Revolution Min/Max: 2 / 20000
Configures the encoder module for the Pulses Per Revolution (Encoder Lines) of
the A Quad B Encoder.
3 Fdbk Loss Cfg Default: 3 = “FltCoastStop” RW Real
Feedback Loss Configure Options: 0 = “Ignore”
Configures how the drive reacts to an error status condition for the feedback. 1 = “Alarm”
2 = “Flt Minor“
3 = “FltCoastStop“
4 Encoder Feedback Default: 0 RO Real
Encoder Feedback Min/Max: –/+2147483647
Displays the position feedback value of the encoder. This should be used as a
source for the main control (port 0) Feedback Select.
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
HomMrk Armed
Options
HomeIn Armed
HomMrk Event
HomeIn Event
Marker Event
A Chan Only
Z Chan Enbl
Inv Home In
Home Input
B Not Input
A Not Input
Z Not Input
Direction
B Input
A Input
Z Input
Default 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 = Condition False
Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 1 = Condition True
Bit 0 “Z Chan Enbl” – State of the corresponding bit in the [Encoder Cfg] parameter.
Bit 1 “A Chan Only” – State of the corresponding bit in the [Encoder Cfg] parameter.
Bit 2 “A Input” – State of encoder A input signal.
Bit 3 “A Not Input” – State of encoder A Not input signal.
Bit 4 “B Input” – State of encoder B input signal.
Bit 5 “B Not Input” – State of encoder B Not input signal.
Bit 6 “Z Input” – State of encoder Z input signal.
Bit 7 “Z Not Input” – State of encoder Z Not input signal.
Bit 8 “Marker Event” – When channel Z (marker pulse) is used, indicates that a marker pulse is detected. Automatically cleared in the homing routine
or due to clearing of encoder faults.
Bit 9 “Inv Home In” – State of the corresponding bit in the [Encoder Cfg] parameter. When set, the home input signal will be inverted.
Bit 10 “Home Input” – Active state of the Home Input signal. This status bit gets inverted if the “Inv Home In” bit is enabled.
Bit 11 “HomeIn Armed” – Indicates that the homing logic is configured to latch the encoder position upon the next transition of the home input.
Bit 12 “HomeIn Event” – Indicates that the homing logic has latched the encoder position in response to a transition of the home input.
Bit 13 “HomMrk Armed” – Indicates that the homing logic is configured to latch the encoder position upon the next marker (Z channel) pulse.
HOST GROUPS
Bit 14 “HomMrk Event” – Indicates that the homing logic has latched the encoder position in response to a marker (Z channel) pulse.
Bit 15 “Direction” – State of the corresponding bit in the [Encoder Cfg] parameter.
6 Error Status
Error Status
Status information that will result in a feedback loss condition.
SI Comm Loss
Options
Phase Loss
Quad Loss
Open Wire
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Bit 0 “Open Wire” – Indicates that an input signal (A, B or Z) is in the same state as its complement (A Not, B Not, Z Not). For open wire detection to
work, the encoder signals must be differential (not single ended). The Z channel is only checked when enabled. -- see [Encoder Cfg].
Bit 1 “Phase Loss” – Indicates that more than 30 phase loss (open wire) events have occurred over an 8msec time period. The same restrictions
apply as on [Encoder Cfg] bit 0.
Bit 2 “Quad Loss” – Quadrature loss events occur when simultaneous edge transitions occur on both the A and B encoder channels. Indicates that
more than 10 quad loss events over a 10 msec time period are detected. Only valid when both A and B channels are used (not 'A Chan Only' in
[Encoder Cfg]).
Bit 15 “SI Comm Loss” – Indicates a communication loss between the main control board and the encoder module over the Serial Interface
backplane.
7 Phase Loss Count Default: 0 RO Real
Phase Loss Count Min/Max: 0 / 127
Displays the active value of the encoder module's phase loss counter hardware
register. Values in this register accumulated over 8 msec are used to detect
Phase Loss errors.
8 Quad Loss Count Default: 0 RO Real
Displays the active value of the encoder module's quad loss counter hardware Min/Max: 0 / 15
register. Values in this register accumulated over 8 msec are used to detect Quad
Loss errors.
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
5 = “2 OSSD”
“2 OSSD” (5) – Dual-channel SS equivalent
6 = “1 NC”
“1 NC” (6) – Single channel equivalent
55 Safe Speed Limit Units: RPM RW Real
Defines the speed limit that will be monitored in Safe Limited Speed (SLS) mode. mm/s
Units are based on rotary or linear configuration defined by P29 [Fbk 1 Units]. Default: 0
Min/Max: 0 / 6553.5 RPM
0 / 6553.5 mm/s
56 Speed Hysteresis Units: % RW Real
Provides hysteresis for SLS_Out output when Safe Limited Speed monitoring is Default: 0
active. Min/Max: 0 / 100
57 Door Out Type Default: 0 = “Pwr to Rel” RW Real
Defines the lock and unlock state for door control output (DC_Out). Options: 0 = “Pwr to Rel”
When Door Out Type equals power to release, DC_Out is OFF in the lock state 1 = “Pwr to Lock”
and ON in the unlock state. 2 = “2 Ch Sourcing”
When Door Out Type equals power to lock, DC_Out is ON in the lock state and
OFF in the unlock state.
The first and middle units of a multi-axis system must be configured as cascading
(2).
58 DM Input Default: 0 = “Not used” RW Real
Configuration for the Door Monitor input (DM_In). Options: 0 = “Not used”
“2NC” (1) – Dual-channel equivalent 1 = “2NC”
“2 NC 3s” (2) – Dual-channel equivalent 3 s 2 = “2 NC 3s”
“1 NO + 1 NC” (3) – Dual-channel complementary 3 = “1 NO + 1 NC”
“1 NO + 1 NC 3s” (4) – Dual-channel complementary 3 s 4 = “1 NO + 1 NC 3s”
5 = “2 OSSD”
“2 OSSD” (5) – Dual-channel SS equivalent
6 = “1 NC”
“1 NC” (6) – Single channel equivalent
59 Lock Mon Enable Default: 0 = “Disable” RW Real
Lock Monitoring can only be enabled when the speed monitoring safety option is Options: 0 = “Disable”
a single unit or as the first unit in a multi-axis system (Cascaded Config equals 0 1 = “Enable”
or 3).
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
Combined Flt
Options
Reset PwrUp
Door Mon Flt
ESM Mon Flt
Mov in Stop
SLS Out Flt
Fbk 2 V Flt
Fbk 1 V Flt
MP Out Flt
DC Out Flt
Invalid Cfg
ESM In Flt
Core Error
SS Out Flt
SLS In Flt
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
DM In Flt
Decel Flt
Fbk 2 Flt
Fbk 1 Flt
LM In Flt
SS In Flt
Accel Flt
Dir Flt
Default 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
Bit 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
Wait No Stop
SDM In Prog
ESM In Prog
SMA In Prog
SMS In Prog
Options
Wait SS Cyc
SLS In Prog
SS Stopped
Config Lock
DM In Prog
Wait Reset
SS In Prog
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
StatusOK
SS Decel
SLS Req
DC Lock
SLS Out
Reset In
SS Req
MP Out
DC Out
ESM In
SS Out
SLS In
DM In
LM In
SS In
Default 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
Bit 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
SLS Out Ch 1
SLS Out Ch 0
Options
MP Out Ch 1
MP Out Ch 0
DC Out Ch 1
DC Out Ch 0
ESM In Ch 1
ESM In Ch 0
SS Out Ch 1
SS Out Ch 0
SLS In Ch 1
SLS In Ch 0
DM In Ch 1
DM In Ch 0
LM In Ch 1
LM In Ch 0
SS In Ch 1
SS In Ch 0
Stop Cmd
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
SLS Cmd
Reserved
Reset In
Default 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
Bit 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
0 = Open
1 = Closed
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
20 = P58 [DM Input Type] value not legal based on P20 [Cascaded Config] and
P21 [Safety Mode] value.
21 = P54 [Enable SW In Typ] value not legal based on P21 [Safety Mode] value.
22 = P60 [Lock Mon In Type] value not legal based on P21 [Safety Mode] value
and P59 [Lock Mon Enable] value.
23 = Illegal P20 [Cascaded Config] value.
24 = Illegal P22 [Reset Type] value.
25 = Reserved
26 = Illegal P45 [Safe Stop Type] value.
27 = Illegal P51 [Stop Decel Tol] value.
28 = Illegal P27 [Fbk Mode] value.
29 = Illegal P28 [Fbk 1 Type] value.
30 = Illegal P31 [Fbk 1 Resolution] value.
31 = Illegal P32 [Fbk1 Volt Mon] value.
32 = Illegal P37 [Fbk 2 Volt Mon] value.
33 = Illegal P24 [OverSpd Response] value.
34 = Reserved
36 = Unknown error (Unknown Err).
72 SS Out Mode Default: 0 = “Pulse test” RW Real
Defines whether the SS_Out output is pulse-tested. Options: 0 = “Pulse test”
If pulse-testing is turned off for any output, the SIL, Category, and PL rating is 1 = “No pulse test”
reduced for the entire PowerFlex safety system.
73 SLS Out Mode Default: 0 = “Pulse test” RW Real
Defines whether the SLS_Out output is pulse-tested. Options: 0 = “Pulse test”
If pulse-testing is turned off for any output, the SIL, Category, and PL rating is 1 = “No pulse test”
reduced for the entire PowerFlex safety system.
74 Door Out Mode Default: 0 = “Pulse test” RW Real
Defines whether the DC_Out output is pulse-tested. Options: 0 = “Pulse test”
If pulse-testing is turned off for any output, the SIL, Category, and PL rating is 1 = “No pulse test”
reduced for the entire PowerFlex safety system.
Dual Incremental
Encoder Module
Parameters
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
Single Ended
Options
A Chan Only
Z Chan Enbl
Edge Mode
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Direction
Default 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 = Condition False
Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 1 = Condition True
Bit 0 “Z Channel Enbl” – Configures the Channel Z to be used and monitored for Phase Loss. A value of 0 = the Z channel will be ignored.
Bit 1 “A Chan Only” – Configures the module to use only the A channel, and ignore the B channel. In this mode, direction cannot be determined, and
HOST GROUPS
Bit 2 “Edge Mode” – Configure the module to use AB edge time data for speed calculation rather than accumulated count.
Bit 4 “Single Ended” – Configure when the A Quad B encoder has single ended signals. In this mode, Phase Loss detection is disabled. 0 =
Differential, 1 = Single Ended
Bit 5 “Direction” – Inverts the position count up/down associated with a given rotation direction internally. 1 = invert, 0 = do not invert
2 Encoder 0 PPR Default: 1024 RW Real
Encoder 0 Pulses Per Revolution Min/Max: 2 / 20000
Configures the encoder module's primary input (Encoder 0) for the Pulses Per
Revolution (Encoder Lines) of the A Quad B Encoder.
3 Enc0 FdbkLss Cfg Default: 3 = “FltCoastStop” RW Real
Encoder 0 Feedback Loss Configure Options: 0 = “Ignore”
Configures how the drive reacts to an error status condition for Encoder 0 1 = “Alarm”
(primary encoder). 2 = “Flt Minor“
3 = “FltCoastStop“
4 Encoder 0 Feedback Default: 0 RO Real
Encoder 0 Feedback Min/Max: –/+2147483647
Displays the position feedback value of Encoder 0 (primary encoder). This should
be used as a source for the main control (port 0) Feedback Select.
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
HomMrk Armed
Options
HomeIn Armed
HomMrk Event
HomeIn Event
Marker Event
A Chan Only
Z Chan Enbl
Inv Home In
Home Input
B Not Input
A Not Input
Z Not Input
Direction
B Input
A Input
Z Input
0 = Condition False
Default 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
1 = Condition True
Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Bit 0 “Z Chan Enbl” – State of the corresponding bit in the [Encoder 0 Cfg] parameter.
Bit 1 “A Chan Only” – State of the corresponding bit in the [Encoder 0 Cfg] parameter.
Bit 2 “A Input” – State of encoder A input signal.
Bit 3 “A Not Input” – State of encoder A Not input signal.
Bit 4 “B Input” – State of encoder B input signal.
Bit 5 “B Not Input” – State of encoder B Not input signal.
Bit 6 “Z Input” – State of encoder Z input signal.
Bit 7 “Z Not Input” – State of encoder Z Not input signal.
Bit 8 “Marker Event” – When channel Z (marker pulse) is used, indicates that a marker pulse is detected. Automatically cleared in the homing routine
or due to clearing of encoder faults.
Bit 9 “Inv Home In” – State of the corresponding bit in the [Encoder 0 Cfg] parameter. When set, the home input signal will be inverted.
Bit 10 “Home Input” – Active state of the Home Input signal. This status bit gets inverted if the “Inv Home In” bit is enabled.
Bit 11 “HomeIn Armed” – Indicates that the homing logic is configured to latch the encoder position upon the next transition of the home input.
Bit 12 “HomeIn Event” – Indicates that the homing logic has latched the encoder position in response to a transition of the home input.
Bit 13 “HomMrk Armed” – Indicates that the homing logic is configured to latch the encoder position upon the next marker (Z channel) pulse.
HOST GROUPS
Bit 14 “HomMrk Event” – Indicates that the homing logic has latched the encoder position in response to a marker (Z channel) pulse.
Encoder 0
Bit 15 “Direction” – State of the corresponding bit in the [Encoder 0 Cfg] parameter.
6 Enc0 Error Sts
Encoder 0 Error Status
Status information that will result in a feedback loss condition for Encoder 0.
SI Comm Loss
Options
Phase Loss
Quad Loss
Open Wire
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Bit 0 “Open Wire” – Indicates that an input signal (A, B or Z) is in the same state as its complement (A Not, B Not, Z Not). For open wire detection to
work, the encoder signals must be differential (not single ended). The Z channel is only checked when enabled.
Bit 1 “Phase Loss” – Indicates that more than 30 phase loss (open wire) events have occurred over an 8msec time period. The same restrictions
apply as on [Encoder 0 Cfg] bit 0.
Bit 2 “Quad Loss” – Quadrature loss events occur when simultaneous edge transitions occur on both the A and B encoder channels. Indicates that
more than 10 quad loss events over a 10 msec time period are detected. Only valid when both A and B channels are used (not 'A Chan Only' in
[Encoder 0 Cfg]).
Bit 15 “SI Comm Loss” – Indicates a communication loss between the main control board and the encoder module over the Serial Interface
backplane.
7 Enc0 PhsLss Cnt Default: 0 RO Real
Encoder 0 Phase Loss Count Min/Max: 0 / 127
Displays the active value of the encoder module's Encoder 0 phase loss counter
hardware register. Values in this register accumulated over 8 msec are used to
detect Phase Loss errors.
8 Enc0 QuadLss Cnt Default: 0 RO Real
Encoder 0 Quad Loss Count Min/Max: 0 / 15
Displays the active value of the encoder module's Encoder 0 quad loss counter
hardware register. Values in this register accumulated over 8 msec are used to
detect Quad Loss errors.
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
Single Ended
Options
A Chan Only
Z Chan Enbl
Edge Mode
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Direction
Default 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 = Condition False
Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 1 = Condition True
Bit 0 “Z Channel Enbl” – Configures the Channel Z to be used and monitored for Phase Loss. A value of 0 = the Z channel will be ignored.
Bit 1 “A Chan Only” – Configures the module to use only the A channel, and ignore the B channel. In this mode, direction cannot be determined, and
HOST GROUPS
Bit 2 “Edge Mode” – Configure the module to use AB edge time data for speed calculation rather than accumulated count.
Bit 4 “Single Ended” – Configure when the A Quad B encoder has single ended signals. In this mode, Phase Loss detection is disabled. 0 =
Differential, 1 = Single Ended
Bit 5 “Direction” – Inverts the position count up/down associated with a given rotation direction internally. 1 = invert, 0 = do not invert
12 Encoder 1 PPR Default: 1024 RW Real
Encoder 1 Pulses Per Revolution Min/Max: 2 / 20000
Configures the encoder module's secondary input (Encoder 1) for the Pulses Per
Revolution (Encoder Lines) of the A Quad B Encoder.
13 Enc1 FdbkLss Cfg Default: 3 = “FltCoastStop” RW Real
Encoder 1 Feedback Loss Min/Max: 0 = “Ignore”
Configures how the drive reacts to an error status condition for Encoder 1 1 = “Alarm”
(secondary encoder). 2 = “Flt Minor“
3 = “FltCoastStop“
14 Encoder 1 Feedback Default: 0 RO Real
Encoder 1 Feedback Min/Max: –/+2147483647
Displays the position feedback value of Encoder 1 (secondary encoder). This
should be used as a source for the main control (port 0) Feedback Select.
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
HomMrk Armed
Options
HomeIn Armed
HomMrk Event
HomeIn Event
Marker Event
A Chan Only
Z Chan Enbl
Inv Home In
Home Input
B Not Input
A Not Input
Z Not Input
Direction
B Input
A Input
Z Input
Default 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 = Condition False
Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 1 = Condition True
Bit 0 “Z Chan Enbl” – State of the corresponding bit in the [Encoder 1 Cfg] parameter.
Bit 1 “A Chan Only” – State of the corresponding bit in the [Encoder 1 Cfg] parameter.
Bit 2 “A Input” – State of encoder A input signal.
Bit 3 “A Not Input” – State of encoder A Not input signal.
Bit 4 “B Input” – State of encoder B input signal.
Bit 5 “B Not Input” – State of encoder B Not input signal.
Bit 6 “Z Input” – State of encoder Z input signal.
Bit 7 “Z Not Input” – State of encoder Z Not input signal.
Bit 8 “Marker Event” – When channel Z (marker pulse) is used, indicates that a marker pulse is detected. Automatically cleared in the homing routine
or due to clearing of encoder faults.
Bit 9 “Inv Home In” – State of the corresponding bit in the [Encoder 1 Cfg] parameter. When set, the home input signal will be inverted.
Bit 10 “Home Input” – Active state of the Home Input signal. This status bit gets inverted if the “Inv Home In” bit is enabled.
Bit 11 “HomeIn Armed” – Indicates that the homing logic is configured to latch the encoder position upon the next transition of the home input.
Bit 12 “HomeIn Event” – Indicates that the homing logic has latched the encoder position in response to a transition of the home input.
Bit 13 “HomMrk Armed” – Indicates that the homing logic is configured to latch the encoder position upon the next marker (Z channel) pulse.
HOST GROUPS
Bit 14 “HomMrk Event” – Indicates that the homing logic has latched the encoder position in response to a marker (Z channel) pulse.
Encoder 1
Bit 15 “Direction” – State of the corresponding bit in the [Encoder 1 Cfg] parameter.
16 Enc1 Error Sts
Encoder 1 Error Status
Status information that will result in a feedback loss condition for Encoder 1.
SI Comm Loss
Options
Phase Loss
Quad Loss
Open Wire
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Bit 0 “Open Wire” – Indicates that an input signal (A, B or Z) is in the same state as its complement (A Not, B Not, Z Not). For open wire detection to
work, the encoder signals must be differential (not single ended). The Z channel is only checked when enabled.
Bit 1 “Phase Loss” – Indicates that more than 30 phase loss (open wire) events have occurred over an 8msec time period. The same restrictions
apply as on [Encoder 1 Cfg] bit 0.
Bit 2 “Quad Loss” – Quadrature loss events occur when simultaneous edge transitions occur on both the A and B encoder channels. Indicates that
more than 10 quad loss events over a 10 msec time period are detected. Only valid when both A and B channels are used (not 'A Chan Only' in
[Encoder 1 Cfg]).
Bit 15 “SI Comm Loss” – Indicates a communication loss between the main control board and the encoder module over the Serial Interface
backplane.
17 Enc1 PhsLss Cnt Default: 0 RO Real
Encoder 1 Phase Loss Count Min/Max: 0 / 127
Displays the active value of the encoder module's Encoder 1 phase loss counter
hardware register. Values in this register accumulated over 8 msec are used to
detect Phase Loss errors.
18 Enc1 QuadLss Cnt Default: 0 RO Real
Encoder 1 Quad Loss Count Min/Max: 0 / 15
Displays the active value of the encoder module's Encoder 1 quad loss counter
hardware register. Values in this register accumulated over 8 msec are used to
detect Quad Loss errors.
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
Inv Home In
Homing Cfg
Options
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Default 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 = Not Inverted
Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 1 = Inverted
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
Default 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 = Cleared
Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 1 = Set
Bit 0 “Safety Mode” – Indicates that the dip switch on the dual encoder module is configured to place its feedback signals on the SI backplane for use
by the Safe Speed Monitor module. If multiple dual encoder modules are present, only one dual encoder can be configured for Safety Mode. 0 =
Safety Mode Off. 1 = Safety Mode On.
Bit 1 “SafetyVoltHi” – Indicates the status (configured by a jumper on the module) of the safety feedback voltage mode. 0 = 5V safety feedback mode,
1 = 12V safety feedback mode.
Universal Feedback
Module Parameters
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
FB0FB1 Cflct
Hardware Err
Alarm Type 2
Alarm Type 1
System Error
Firmware Err
Module Error
Options
EncOut Cflct
Safety Cflct
DPI Ready
Sec Safety
FB1 Alarm
FB0 Alarm
Cfg Alarm
Initializing
FB1 Error
FB0 Error
Pri Safety
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Default 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
Bit 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
0 = False
1 = True
Bit 0 “Module Error” – Indicates that the Feedback Option Board has any error. This bit is set if at least one of the bits “FB0 Error”, “FB1 Error”, or
“System Error” is set.
Bit 1 “Alarm Type 1” – Indicates that there is any alarm of type 1 active on the Feedback Option Board. Bits 8…10 indicate what kind of alarm is
active.
Bit 2 “Alarm Type 2” – Indicates that there is any alarm of type 2 active on the Feedback Option Board. Bits 20 and 21 indicate what kind of alarm is
active.
Bit 4 “FB0 Error” – Indicates that Feedback 0 has an error. This bit is set if any Feedback 0 error bit in P10 [FB0 Sts] is set. If this bit is set, the bit
“Module Error” is also set.
Bit 5 “FB1 Error” – Indicates that Feedback 1 has an error. This bit is set if any Feedback 1 error bit in P10 [FB1 Sts] is set. If this bit is set, the bit
“Module Error” is also set.
Bit 6 “System Error” – Indicates that there is a feedback independent error on the Feedback Option Board. Bits 12 and 13 show the type of the
System Error. If this bit is set, the bit “Module Error” is also set.
Bit 8 “FB0 Alarm” – Indicates that Feedback 0 has an alarm This bit is set if there is an alarm in the Feedback 0 encoder. If this bit is set, the bit
HOST GROUPS
Bit 9 “FB1 Alarm” – Indicates that Feedback 1 has an alarm This bit is set if there is an alarm in the Feedback 1 encoder. If this bit is set, the bit
“Alarm Type 1” is also set.
Bit 10 “Cfg Alarm” – Indicates that there is a feedback independent alarm on the Feedback Option Board. Bits 16 and 17 show the type of the Cfg
Alarm. If this bit is set, Bit 1 “Alarm Type 1” is also set.
Bit 12 “Hardware Err” – Indicates that there is a Hardware Error on the Feedback Option Board. If this bit is set, Bit 6 “System Error” is also set.
Bit 13 “Firmware Err” – Indicates that there is a Firmware Error on the Feedback Option Board. A Firmware Error occurs if the Hardware and the
downloaded Firmware are not compatible. If this bit is set, Bit 6 “System Error” is also set.
Bit 16 “EncOut Cflct” – If set, there is one of the following problems with the Encoder Output:
• The selection in P80 [Enc Out Sel] is not possible since the required pins on the terminal blocks are already used for Feedback 0 or 1 according to
P6 [FB0 Device Sel] and P36 [FB1 Device Sel].
• P80 [Enc Out Sel] is set to “Sine Cosine” and there is no signal connected to the pins 1-4 of the Terminal Block 1.
• P80 [Enc Out Sel] is set to “Sine Cosine”, the value of [FBX IncAndSC PPR] is not a power of two, and the parameter P84 [Enc Out Z PPR] is not
set to 0 “1 ZPulse”. This is not allowed.
• P80 [Enc Out Sel] is set to “Channel X” or “Channel Y” and there is no encoder connected to that channel.
• P80 [Enc Out Sel] is set to “Channel X” or “Channel Y” and there is a linear encoder connected to this channel. If this bit is set, the bit “Board
Alarm” is also set.
Bit 17 “Safety Cflct” – If set, the Safety DIP switches are in an invalid position. If this bit is set, Bit 10 “Cfg Alarm” is also set.
Bit 20 “FB0FB1 Cflct” – If set, the combination of the feedback selection done with the parameters P6 [FB0 Device Sel] and P36 [FB1 Device Sel] is
invalid, i.e. both feedbacks have Sin-Cos-Signals (There is only place for one set of Sin-Cos-Signals on the Terminal Blocks). If this bit is set, Bit 2
“Alarm Type 2” is also set.
Bit 21 “Initializing” – Indicates that the Universal Feedback State Machine is in the Initialize State. This Type 2 alarm makes sure that the motor
cannot be started during this. If this bit is set, the bit “Alarm Type 2” is also set.
Bit 29 “Pri Safety” – Indicates that the UFB is used as primary safety board.
Bit 30 “Sec Safety” – Indicates that the UFB is used as secondary safety board.
Bit 31 “DPI Ready” – This bit tells the MCB if the UFB is ready for DPI communication.
2 Module Err Reset Default: 0 = “Ready” RW 32-bit
Module Error Reset Options: 0 = “Ready” Integer
Selects the module reset type. 1 = “Clr FB Intlz”
2 = “Clear Errors“
3 = “FB Initlz“
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
7 FB0 Identify
Feedback 0 Identify
Displays the used encoder type for feedback 0, e.g. Multi turn, rotary encoder with EnDat 2.1 interface including SIN/COS incremental signals.
Temposonic
Incremental
Options
Single Turn
EnDat 2p2
EnDat 2p1
Full Digital
Enh Resol
Multi Turn
Reserved
Hiperface
Sin Cos
Rotary
Linear
Stahl
BiSS
SSI
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
FD Low Baud
Options
SC Quadrant
24-bit Resol
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Direction
Default 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 = Condition False
Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 1 = Condition True
Feedback 0 Status
Feedback 0
Options
SC Amplitude
Encoder Alm
SpplyVltRng
Unsupp Enc
Encoder Err
Phase Loss
Quad Loss
Open Wire
Diagnostic
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Timeout
Comm
Bit 0 “Encoder Err” – When asserted, there is an Encoder Error. See [Fdbk0 EnDat Sts], [Hiperface Status], [Fdbk0 BiSS Sts], or [FB0 LinStahl Sts]
for more detail.
Bit 1 “Msg Checksum” – When asserted, the module has experienced a checksum error while attempting to communicate to an encoder via the serial
communication channel.
Bit 2 “Timeout” – When asserted, the module has experienced a time out condition while attempting to communicate to the encoder via the serial
communication channel.
Bit 3 “Comm” – When asserted, there was an error (except Checksum and Time Out) while attempting to communicate to an encoder via the serial
communication channel.
Bit 4 “Diagnostic” – When asserted, the module has experienced a diagnostic test failure on power up.
Bit 5 “SpplyVltRng” – When asserted, the voltage source to the encoder is out of range.
Bit 6 “SC Amplitude” – When asserted, the module detected that the encoder signal amplitude is out of tolerance.
Bit 7 “Open Wire” – When asserted, the module has detected an open wire.
Bit 8 “Quad Loss” – Indicates that there is a signal quadrature error.
Bit 9 “Phase Loss” – Indicates that an A or B signal of an A Quad B Incremental encoder is disconnected.
Bit 10 “Unsupp Enc” – Indicates that the connected encoder is not supported. If it is a BiSS encoder, the encoder has to be configured manually with
the Diagnostic Parameters [BiSS ManConfig1] and [BiSS ManConfig2].
Bit 12 “Encoder Alm” – When asserted, there is an Encoder Alarm. See [Fdbk0 EnDat Sts], [Hiperface Status], [Fdbk0 BiSS Sts], or [FB0 LinStahl
Sts] for more detail.
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
A Chan Only
Z Chan Enbl
Edge Mode
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Bit 0 “Z Chan Enbl” – When set, Channel Z is also monitored for Phase Loss. When cleared, Channel Z is ignored for Phase Loss detection.
Only used if [FB0 Device Sel] = “Inc A B Z”.
Bit 1 “A Chan Only” – When set, logic monitors only channel A. When clear, logic monitors both A and B.
Bit 2 “Edge Mode” – When set, speed calc uses AB edge data. When clear, speed calc does not use AB edge data.
Bit 4 “Single Ended” – This bit has to be set if the connected A Quad B encoder has single ended signals. For these encoders, the Phase Loss
detection is switched off.
17 FB0 Inc Sts
Feedback 0 Incremental Status
Displays Incremental Feedback status for feedback 0.
A Chan Only
Z Chan Enbl
Options
B Not Input
A Not Input
Z Not Input
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
B Input
A Input
Z Input
Bit 0 “Z Chan Enbl” – Indicates that Channel Z is monitored for Phase Loss. Only used if [FB0 Device Sel] = “Inc A B Z”.
Bit 1 “A Chan Only” – Indicates only A channel is monitored, B channel not used.
Bit 2 “A Input” – State of encoder A input signal
Bit 3 “A Not Input” – State of encoder A Not input signal
Bit 4 “B Input” – State of encoder B input signal
Bit 5 “B Not Input” – State of encoder B Not input signal
Bit 6 “Z Input” – State of encoder Z input signal
Bit 7 “Z Not Input” – State of encoder Z Not input signal
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
DblWordQuery
Options
Reserved
Parity Bit
Default 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 0 1 0 0 0 = Condition False
Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 1 = Condition True
Bit 0 “Parity Bit” – If set, SSI encoder has to support a parity bit (even parity).
Bit 2 “Gray Code” – Enables the gray to binary conversion of the position.
Bit 3 “Err Bit Enbl” – If set, there is an error bit transmitted by the encoder.
Bit 4 “DblWordQuery” – If set, a Double Word Query is executed at startup which means that the same position is transmitted twice by the encoder. If
the 2 positions are not identical, the “Comm” error bit in [Fdbkx Status] is set. This bit only needs to be cleared if the encoder does not support
Double Word Query and it does not send zeros instead of the second position (which it actually should according to the SSI specification).
21 FB0 SSI Resol Units: Bits RW 32-bit
Feedback 0 SSI Resolve Default: 13 Integer
Configures the number of bits for the position within one revolution (resolution) of Min/Max: 8 / 32
the SSI encoder for feedback 0.
22 FB0 SSI Turns Units: Bits RW 32-bit
Feedback 0 SSI Turns Default: 12 Integer
Configures the number of bits for the revolutions of the SSI encoder for feedback Min/Max: 0 / 16
0.
HOST GROUPS
Feedback 0
OutOfRailAlm
Options
Read Head 2
Read Head 1
Optics Alarm
OutOfRailErr
No Position
ROM Error
RAM Error
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Bit 0 “Optics Alarm” – Displays an alarm when fiber optics require cleaning.
Bit 1 “OutOfRailAlm” – Indicates that the read encoder count is at the maximum value (524'287).
Bit 4 “OutOfRailErr” – Indicates that there is no rail anymore between the read head.
Bit 8 “Read Head 1” – Indicates that the read head must be cleaned or installed correctly.
Bit 9 “Read Head 2” – Indicates that the read head must be cleaned or installed correctly.
Bit 10 “RAM Error” – Indicates a RAM error. Reading head needs to be repaired.
Bit 11 “EPROM Error” – Indicates an EPROM error. Reading head needs to be repaired.
Bit 12 “ROM Error” – Indicates a ROM error. Reading head needs to be repaired.
Bit 14 “No Position” – Indicates that no position value was available. Only happens after power on or reset.
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
37 FB1 Identify
Feedback 1 Identify
Displays the used encoder type for feedback 1, e.g. Multi turn, rotary encoder with EnDat 2.1 interface including SIN/COS incremental signals.
Temposonic
Incremental
Options
Single Turn
EnDat 2p2
EnDat 2p1
Full Digital
Enh Resol
Multi Turn
Reserved
Hiperface
Sin Cos
Rotary
Linear
Stahl
BiSS
SSI
Default 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
0 = Condition False
Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 1 = Condition True
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
FD Low Baud
Options
SC Quadrant
24-bit Resol
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Direction
Default 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 = Condition False
Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 1 = Condition True
Feedback 1 Status
Feedback 1
Options
SC Amplitude
Encoder Alm
SpplyVltRng
Unsupp Enc
Encoder Err
Phase Loss
Quad Loss
Open Wire
Diagnostic
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Timeout
Comm
Bit 0 “Encoder Err” – When asserted, there is an Encoder Error. See [Fdbk1 EnDat Sts], [Hiperface Status], [Fdbk1 BiSS Sts], or [FB1 LinStahl Sts]
for more detail.
Bit 1 “Msg Checksum” – When asserted, the module has experienced a checksum error while attempting to communicate to an encoder via the serial
communication channel.
Bit 2 “Timeout” – When asserted, the module has experienced a time out condition while attempting to communicate to the encoder via the serial
communication channel.
Bit 3 “Comm” – When asserted, there was an error (except Checksum and Time Out) while attempting to communicate to an encoder via the serial
communication channel.
Bit 4 “Diagnostic” – When asserted, the module has experienced a diagnostic test failure on power up.
Bit 5 “SpplyVltRng” – When asserted, the voltage source to the encoder is out of range.
Bit 6 “SC Amplitude” – When asserted, the module detected that the encoder signal amplitude is out of tolerance.
Bit 7 “Open Wire” – When asserted, the module has detected an open wire.
Bit 8 “Quad Loss” – Indicates that there is a signal quadrature error.
Bit 9 “Phase Loss” – Indicates that an A or B signal of an A Quad B Incremental encoder is disconnected.
Bit 10 “Unsupp Enc” – Indicates that the connected encoder is not supported. If it is a BiSS encoder, the encoder has to be configured manually with
the Diagnostic Parameters [BiSS ManConfig1] and [BiSS ManConfig2].
Bit 12 “Encoder Alm” – When asserted, there is an Encoder Alarm. See [Fdbk1 EnDat Sts], [Hiperface Status], [Fdbk1 BiSS Sts], or [FB1 LinStahl
Sts] for more detail.
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
A Chan Only
Z Chan Enbl
Edge Mode
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Bit 0 “Z Chan Enbl” – When set, Channel Z is also monitored for Phase Loss. When cleared, Channel Z is ignored for Phase Loss detection.
Only used if [FB0 Device Sel] = “Inc A B Z”.
Bit 1 “A Chan Only” – When set, logic monitors only channel A. When clear, logic monitors both A and B.
Bit 2 “Edge Mode” – When set, speed calc uses AB edge data. When clear, speed calc does not use AB edge data.
Bit 4 “Single Ended” – This bit has to be set if the connected A Quad B encoder has single ended signals. For these encoders, the Phase Loss
detection is switched off.
47 FB1 Inc Sts
Feedback 1 Incremental Status
Displays Incremental Feedback status for feedback 1.
A Chan Only
Z Chan Enbl
Options
B Not Input
A Not Input
Z Not Input
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
B Input
A Input
Z Input
Bit 0 “Z Chan Enbl” – Indicates that Channel Z is monitored for Phase Loss. Only used if [FB1 Device Sel] = “Inc A B Z”.
Bit 1 “A Chan Only” – Indicates only A channel is monitored, B channel not used.
Bit 2 “A Input” – State of encoder A input signal
Bit 3 “A Not Input” – State of encoder A Not input signal
Bit 4 “B Input” – State of encoder B input signal
Bit 5 “B Not Input” – State of encoder B Not input signal
Bit 6 “Z Input” – State of encoder Z input signal
Bit 7 “Z Not Input” – State of encoder Z Not input signal
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
DblWordQuery
Options
Reserved
Parity Bit
Default 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 0 1 0 0 0 = Condition False
Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 1 = Condition True
Bit 0 “Parity Bit” – If set, SSI encoder has to support a parity bit (even parity).
Bit 2 “Gray Code” – Enables the gray to binary conversion of the position.
Bit 3 “Err Bit Enbl” – If set, there is an error bit transmitted by the encoder.
Bit 4 “DblWordQuery” – If set, a Double Word Query is executed at startup which means that the same position is transmitted twice by the encoder. If
the 2 positions are not identical, the “Comm” error bit in [Fdbkx Status] is set. This bit only needs to be cleared if the encoder does not support
Double Word Query and it does not send zeros instead of the second position (which it actually should according to the SSI specification).
51 FB1 SSI Resol Units: Bits RW 32-bit
Feedback 1 SSI Resolve Default: 13 Integer
Configures the number of bits for the position within one revolution (resolution) of Min/Max: 8 / 32
the SSI encoder for feedback 1.
52 FB1 SSI Turns Units: Bits RW 32-bit
Feedback 1 SSI Turns Default: 12 Integer
Configures the number of bits for the revolutions of the SSI encoder for feedback Min/Max: 0 / 16
1.
HOST GROUPS
Feedback 1
OutOfRailAlm
Options
Read Head 2
Read Head 1
Optics Alarm
OutOfRailErr
No Position
ROM Error
RAM Error
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Bit 0 “Optics Alarm” – Displays an alarm when fiber optics require cleaning.
Bit 1 “OutOfRailAlm” – Indicates that the read encoder count is at the maximum value (524'287).
Bit 4 “OutOfRailErr” – Indicates that there is no rail anymore between the read head.
Bit 8 “Read Head 1” – Indicates that the read head must be cleaned or installed correctly.
Bit 9 “Read Head 2” – Indicates that the read head must be cleaned or installed correctly.
Bit 10 “RAM Error” – Indicates a RAM error. Reading head needs to be repaired.
Bit 11 “EPROM Error” – Indicates an EPROM error. Reading head needs to be repaired.
Bit 12 “ROM Error” – Indicates a ROM error. Reading head needs to be repaired.
Bit 14 “No Position” – Indicates that no position value was available. Only happens after power on or reset.
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
Specifies the encoder output PPR for the simulated encoder mode ([Enc Out Sel] 1 = “1024 PPR”
= “Virtual Master” or “Channel X” or “Channel Y”). In the emulated encoder mode, 2 = “2048 PPR”
the SIN/COS signals PPR defines the encoder output PPR. 3 = “4096 PPR”
83 Enc Out Z Offset Units: PPR RW 32-bit
Encoder Output Z Offset Default: 0 Integer
Configures the offset of the Z pulse for the emulated/simulated encoder output. Min/Max: 0 / 100000
The marker offset is specified within one revolution.
84 Enc Out Z PPR Default: 0 = “1 Z-Pulse” RW 32-bit
Encoder Output Z PPR Options: 0 = “1 Z-Pulse” Integer
Configures the number of Z-Pulses per revolution. 1 = “2 Z-Pulses”
2 = “4 Z-Pulses”
3 = “8 Z-Pulses”
4 = “16 Z-Pulses”
5 = “32 Z-Pulses”
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
Options
Arm Latch 9
Arm Latch 8
Arm Latch 7
Arm Latch 6
Arm Latch 5
Arm Latch 4
Arm Latch 3
Arm Latch 2
Arm Latch 1
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
signal. The filter delay is programmable in increments of 100 nanoseconds from 0 4 = “400 ns”
(or no delay) up to 1500 nanoseconds.
5 = “500 ns”
6 = “600 ns”
7 = “700 ns”
8 = “800 ns”
9 = “900 ns”
10 = “1000 ns”
11 = “1100 ns”
12 = “1200 ns”
13 = “1300 ns”
14 = “1400 ns”
15 = “1500 ns”
94 Rgsn Sts
Registration Status
Status of the configured registration events.
Latch10Armed
Options
Latch10Found
Latch9 Armed
Latch8 Armed
Latch7 Armed
Latch6 Armed
Latch5 Armed
Latch4 Armed
Latch3 Armed
Latch2 Armed
Latch1 Armed
Latch9 Found
Latch8 Found
Latch7 Found
Latch6 Found
Latch5 Found
Latch4 Found
Latch3 Found
Latch2 Found
Latch1 Found
Rgsn Input 1
Rgsn Input 0
Home Input
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Default 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
Bit 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
0 = False
1 = True
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
Stg1EdgeRise
Options
Stg2EdgeFall
Stg1EdgeFall
Fwd Capture
Rev Capture
Logic Sel b1
Logic Sel b0
Channel Sel
Stg2 In b1
Stg2 In b0
Stg1 In b1
Stg1 In b0
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Default 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 = Condition False
Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 1 = Condition True
Bit 6 “Stg1EdgeRise” – Latch stage 1 edge/level select: Rising edge or high level
Registration
Bit 7 “Stg1EdgeFall” – Latch stage 1 edge/level select: Falling edge or low level
Bit 8 “Logic Sel b0” – Trigger stage combination logic
Bit 9 “Logic Sel b1” – Trigger stage combination logic
Bit 10 “Stg2 In b0” – Latch stage 2 input selection b0
Bit 11 “Stg2 In b1” – Latch stage 2 input selection b1
Bit 13 “Stg2EdgeRise” – Latch stage 2 edge/level select: Rising edge or high level
Bit 14 “Stg2EdgeFall” – Latch stage 2 edge/level select: Falling edge or low level
101 Rgsn Latch1 Psn Default: 0 RO 32-bit
104 Rgsn Latch2 Psn Min/Max: 2147483648 / 2147483647 Integer
107 Rgsn Latch3 Psn
110 Rgsn Latch4 Psn
113 Rgsn Latch5 Psn
116 Rgsn Latch6 Psn
119 Rgsn Latch7 Psn
122 Rgsn Latch8 Psn
125 Rgsn Latch9 Psn
128 Rgsn Latch10 Psn
Registration Latch X Position
Position Captured during the Registration Event for Latch X.
102 Rgsn Latch1 Time Units: Cnt RO 32-bit
105 Rgsn Latch2 Time Default: 0 Integer
108 Rgsn Latch3 Time Min/Max: 0 / 4294967295
111 Rgsn Latch4 Time
114 Rgsn Latch5 Time
117 Rgsn Latch6 Time
120 Rgsn Latch7 Time
123 Rgsn Latch8 Time
126 Rgsn Latch9 Time
129 Rgsn Latch10 Time
Registration Latch X Time
Time Captured when the Registration Event occurred for Latch X.
Embedded EtherNet/
IP Parameters
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
To Net 01] to read Parameter 01 of an optional I/O module plugged into drive Port
4. The value for P17 [DL To Net 01] would be 40001 [(10000 x 4) + 1].
33 Port Number Default: 13 RO Real
Port number Value: 13
Displays the drive port to which the embedded EtherNet/IP adapter is dedicated.
This is always Port 13.
34 DLs From Net Act Default: 0 RO Real
Datalinks From Network Actual Min/Max: 0 / 16
Displays the number of actual controller-to- drive Datalinks that the drive
is using based on the I/O connection opened by the controller.
35 DLs To Net Act Default: 0 RO Real
Datalinks To Network Actual Min/Max: 0 / 16
Displays the number of actual drive-to- controller Datalinks that the
controller is using based on the I/O connection opened by the controller.
36 BOOTP Default: 1 = “Enabled” RW Real
BOOTP Options: 0 = “Disabled”
Configures the adapter to use BOOTP so that you can set its IP 1 = “Enable”
address, subnet mask, and gateway address with a BOOTP server.
When this parameter is disabled, you must use the adapter parameters
to set these addressing functions.
37 Net Addr Src Default: 0 = “Switches” RO Real
Network Address Source Options: 0 = “Switches”
Displays the source from which the adapter node address is taken. This will be 1 = “Parameters”
switches, Parameters 40…43 [IP Addr Cfg x], or BOOTP. It is determined by the 2 = “BOOTP”
settings of the octet switches on the adapter. See Establishing A Connection With
EtherNet/IP on page 2-2 for details.
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
[Subnet Cfg 1]
[Subnet Cfg 2]
[Subnet Cfg 3]
HOST GROUPS
[Subnet Cfg 4]
Important: To set the subnet mask using these parameters, P36 [BOOTP] must
be set to “0” (Disabled).
46 Gateway Cfg 1 Default: 0 RW Real
47 Gateway Cfg 2 Min/Max: 0 / 255
48 Gateway Cfg 3
49 Gateway Cfg 4
Gateway Configure 1…4
Sets the bytes of the gateway address.
255 . 255 . 255 . 255
[Gateway Cfg 1]
[Gateway Cfg 2]
[Gateway Cfg 3]
[Gateway Cfg 4]
Important: To set the gateway address using these parameters, P36 [BOOTP]
must be set to “0” (Disabled).
50 Net Rate Cfg Default: 0 = “Autodetect” RW 32-bit
Network Rate Configure Options: 0 = “Autodetect” Integer
Sets the network data rate at which the adapter communicates. (Updates P51 1 = “10Mbps Full”
[Net Rate Act] after a reset.) 2 = “10Mbps Half”
3 = “100Mbps Full”
4 = “100Mbps Half”
51 Net Rate Act Default: 0 = “No Link” RO 32-bit
Network Rate Actual Options: 0 = “No Link” Integer
Displays the actual network data rate used by the adapter. 1 = “10Mbps Full”
2 = “10Mbps Half”
3 = “100Mbps Full”
4 = “100Mbps Half”
5 = “Dup IP Addr
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
E-mail Cfg
Options
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Default 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 = Disabled
Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 1 = Enabled
ATTENTION: Risk of injury or equipment damage exists. P54 [Comm Flt Action] lets you determine the
action of the adapter and connected drive if I/O communications are disrupted. By default, this parameter
! faults the drive. You can set this parameter so that the drive continues to run. Precautions should be taken to
ensure that the setting of this parameter does not create a risk of injury or equipment damage. When
commissioning the drive, verify that your system responds correctly to various situations (for example, a
HOST GROUPS
disconnected cable).
ATTENTION: Risk of injury or equipment damage exists. P55 [Idle Flt Action] lets you determine the
action of the adapter and connected drive when the controller is idle. By default, this parameter faults the
! drive. You can set this parameter so that the drive continues to run. Precautions should be taken to ensure that
the setting of this parameter does not create a risk of injury or equipment damage. When commissioning the
drive, verify that your system responds correctly to various situations (for example, a controller in idle state).
ATTENTION: Risk of injury or equipment damage exists. P56 [Peer Flt Action] lets you determine the
action of the adapter and connected drive if the adapter is unable to communicate with the designated peer.
! By default, this parameter faults the drive. You can set this parameter so that the drive continues to run.
Precautions should be taken to ensure that the setting of this parameter does not create a risk of injury or
equipment damage. When commissioning the drive, verify that your system responds correctly to various
situations (for example, a disconnected cable).
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
ATTENTION: Risk of injury or equipment damage exists. P57 [Msg Flt Action] lets you determine the
action of the adapter and connected drive if explicit messaging for drive control is disrupted. By default, this
! parameter faults the drive. You can set this parameter so that the drive continues to run. Precautions should be
taken to ensure that the setting of this parameter does not create a risk of injury or equipment damage. When
commissioning the drive, verify that your system responds correctly to various situations (for example, a
disconnected cable).
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
Important: The Peer Inp Addr must be on the same subnet as the embedded
EtherNet/IP adapter.
Changes to these parameters are ignored when P85 [Fr Peer Enable] is “1” (On).
85 Fr Peer Enable Default: 0 = “Off” RW 32-bit
From Peer Enable Options: 0 = “Off” Integer
Controls whether Peer I/O input is operating. A value of “0” (Off) turns off Peer I/O 1 = “Cmd/Ref”
input. A value of “1” (Cmd/Ref) overrides the settings in Parameters P76 [DLs Fr 2 = “Custom”
Peer Cfg], P78 [Logic Src Cfg], and P79 [Ref Src Cfg] and automatically uses
peer Datalink 01 as the drive's present Logic Command and peer Datalink 02 as
the drive's Reference. A value of “2” (Custom) enables peer I/O input using the
Datalink count and settings provided by the user.
86 Fr Peer Status Default: 0 = “Off” RW 32-bit
From Peer Status Options: 0 = “Off” Integer
Displays the status of the consumed Peer I/O input connection. 1 = “Waiting”
2 = “Running”
3 = “Faulted”
87 DLs To Peer Cfg Default: 0 RW Real
Datalinks To Peer Configure Min/Max: 0 / 16
Sets the number of drive-to-network Datalinks (parameters) that are used for
Peer I/O. The Datalinks being used are allocated from the end of the list. For
example, if this parameter's value is set to “3”, Datalinks 14…16 are allocated for
the 3 selected Datalinks. The Datalinks allocated for this cannot overlap with
other assigned DL To Net 01…16 parameters.
88 DLs To Peer Act Default: 0 RO Real
Datalinks To Peer Action Min/Max: 0 / 16
Displays the value of P87 [DLs To Peer Cfg] at the time the drive was reset. This
is the number of actual drive-to-peer Datalinks that the drive is expecting.
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
Sets the maximum time that an adapter will wait when transmitting data to a peer.
The value of P89 [To Peer Period] is multiplied by the value of this parameter to
set the time.
Important: Changes to this parameter are ignored when P91 [To Peer Enable] is
“0” (Off).
91 To Peer Enable Default: 0 = “Off” RW 32-bit
To Peer Enable Options: 0 = “Off” Integer
Controls whether Peer I/O output is operating. A value of “0” (Off) turns off Peer I/ 1 = “Cmd/Ref”
O output. A value of “1” (Cmd/Ref) overrides the settings in Parameters P31 [DL 2 = “Custom”
To Net 15], P32 [DL To Net 16], P76 [DLs Fr Peer Cfg], and P77 [DLs Fr Peer
Act], and automatically sends the drive's present Logic Command (as Datalink
01) and Reference (as Datalink 02). A value of “2” (Custom) enables Peer I/O
output using the Datalink count and settings provided by the user.
Troubleshooting
Faults and Alarms A fault is a condition that stops the drive. There are three types of faults.
Type Description
Auto Reset Run When this type of fault occurs, and parameter [Auto Rstrt Tries] is set to a value
greater than “0,” a user-configurable timer, [Auto Rstrt Delay] begins. When the
timer reaches zero, the drive attempts to automatically reset the fault. If the
condition that caused the fault is no longer present, the fault will be reset and the
drive will be restarted. “Auto Reset Run” faults are identified by “Y” in the “Auto
Reset” column in Table 4.A on page 4-2.
Non-Resettable This type of fault normally requires drive or motor repair. The cause of the fault must
be corrected before the fault can be cleared. The fault will be reset on power up
after repair. Non-Resettable faults are identified by “Fault” in the “Type” column in
Table 4.A on page 4-2.
Configurable These faults can be enabled/disabled to annunciate or ignore a fault condition.
Faults that are configurable are identified by “Configurable” in the “Type” column in
Table 4.A on page 4-2. The parameter used to configure this type of fault is
identified in the “Configuration Parameter” column in Table 4.A on page 4-2.
An alarm is a condition that, if left unaddressed, may stop the drive. There
are two types of alarms.
Type Description
Configurable These alarms can be enabled or disabled using parameter [Alarm Config 1].
Alarms that are configurable are identified as “Alarm 1” in the “Type” column in
Table 4.A on page 4-2 The parameter used to configure this type of alarm is
identified in the “Configuration Parameter” column in Table 4.A on page 4-2.
Non-Configurable These alarms are always enabled. Alarms that are not configurable are identified
as “Alarm 2” in the “Type” column in Table 4.A on page 4-2.
Drive Status The condition or state or your drive is constantly monitored. Any changes
will be indicated throught the LEDs and/or the HIM (if present).
Table 4.A Drive Status Indicator Descriptions
Name Color State Description
STS Green Flashing Drive ready, but not running & no faults are present.
(Status) Steady Drive running, no faults are present.
Yellow Flashing When running, a type 2 (non-configurable) alarm condition
exists, drive continues to run. When stopped, a start inhibit
exists and the drive cannot be started.
7
8
9
Steady A type 1 (user configurable) alarm condition exists, but drive
4
5
0
6
3 continues to run.
Red Flashing A major fault has occurred. Drive will stop. Drive cannot be
started until fault condition is cleared.
Steady A non-resettable fault has occurred.
Red / Flashing A minor fault has occurred. Use parameter 950 [Minor Flt
Yellow Alternately Config] to enable. If not enabled acts like a major fault. When
running, drive continues to run. System is brought to a stop
under system control. Fault must be cleared to continue.
Yellow / Flashing When running, a type 1 alarm condition exists.
Green Alternately
Green / Flashing Drive is flash upgrading.
Red Alternately
ENET Unlit Off The embedded EtherNet/IP adapter and/or network is not
powered, the adapter is not properly connected to the network,
or the adapter needs an IP address.
Red Steady The embedded EtherNet/IP adapter failed the duplicate IP
address detection test.
Red Flashing An EtherNet/IP connection has timed out.
Red / Flashing The embedded EtherNet/IP adapter is performing a self-test.
Green
Green Flashing The embedded EtherNet/IP adapter is properly connected but is
not communicating with any devices on the network.
Green Steady The embedded EtherNet/IP adapter is properly connected and
communicating on the network.
LINK Unlit Off The embedded EtherNet/IP adapter is not powered or is not
transmitting on the network.
Green Flashing The embedded EtherNet/IP adapter is transmitting on the
network.
Important: The Status Indicator LEDs on the HIM cradle do not indicate
the current status of an installed Communication Adapter
option. If an optional Communication Adapter is installed, refer
to that option’s user manual for a description of LED location
and indication.
Stopped AUTO
0.00 Hz F
– – FAULTED – –
Fault Code 81
DPI Port1 Loss
Elapsed Time 01:26:37
ESC CLR
Fault and Alarm The table below contains a list of faults and alarms, the type of fault or
Descriptions alarm, the action taken when the drive faults, the parameter used to
configure the fault or alarm (if applicable), and a description and action
(where applicable).
Table 4.B Fault and Alarm Types, Descriptions and Actions
Fault Configuration Auto
No. Fault/Alarm Text Type Action Parameter Reset Description/Action(s)
0 No Entry
2 Auxiliary Input Fault Coast An auxiliary input interlock is open.
3 Power Loss Configurable 449 Y The DC bus voltage remained below the [Pwr Loss X Level]
Power Loss Actn of nominal for longer than the time programmed in [Pwr Loss
X Time].
4 UnderVoltage Configurable 460 Y If the bus voltage Par 11 falls below the value set in Par 461
UnderVltg Action [UnderVltg Level] an undervoltage condition exists.
5 OverVoltage Fault Coast Y The DC bus voltage exceeded the maximum value.
7 Motor Overload Configurable 410 Y An internal electronic overload trip has occurred.
Motor OL Actn
8 Heatsink OvrTemp Fault Coast The heatsink temperature has exceeded 100% of the drive
Temperature.
9 Trnsistr OvrTemp Fault Coast Y The output transistors have exceeded the maximum
operating temperature.
12 HW OverCurrent Fault Coast Y The drive output current has exceeded the hardware current
limit.
13 Fault Fault Coast Y A current path to earth ground greater than approximately
40% of drive rating has occurred.
14 Ground Warning Alarm 1 The ground current has exceeded the level set in [Gnd Warn
Level].
15 Load Loss Configurable 441 The output torque current is below the value programmed in
Load Loss Action [Load Loss Level] for a time period greater than the time
programmed in [Load Loss Time].
17 Input Phase Loss Configurable 462 The DC bus ripple has exceeded a preset level.
InPhase LossActn
20 TorqPrv Spd Band Fault Coast The difference between the [Commanded Speed] and
[Encoder Speed] has exceeded the level programmed in [Spd
Dev Band] for a time period greater than the time
programmed in [Spd Band Integrat].
21 Output PhaseLoss Configurable 444 The current in one or more phases has been lost or remains
OutPhaseLossActn below a preset level.
24 Decel Inhibit Configurable 409 The drive is not following a commanded deceleration
Dec Inhibit Actn because it is attempting to limit the bus voltage.
25 OverSpeed Limit Fault Coast Y Functions such as Slip Compensation or Bus Regulation
have attempted to add an output frequency adjustment
greater than that programmed in [Overspeed Limit].
26 Brake Slipped Alarm 1 & 2 The encoder movement has exceeded the level in [Brake Slip
Count] after the brake was set.
27 Torq Prove Cflct Alarm 2 When [Torq Prove Config] is enabled, [Motor Ctrl Sel],
[Feedback Select] and [Motor Fdbk Type] must be properly
set.
28 TP Encls Config Fault
33 AuRsts Exhausted Fault Coast The drive unsuccessfully attempted to reset a fault and
resume running for the programmed number of tries.
36 SW OverCurrent Fault Coast Y The drive output current has exceeded the 1 ms current
rating. This rating is greater than the 3 second current rating
and less than the hardware overcurrent fault level. It is
typically 200-250% of the drive continuous rating.
38 Phase U to Grnd Fault Coast A phase to ground fault has been detected between the drive
39 Phase V to Grnd and motor in this phase.
40 Phase W to Grnd
Common Symptoms and Drive does not Start from Start or Run Inputs wired to the terminal block.
Corrective Actions Cause(s) Indication Corrective Action
Drive is Faulted Flashing red Clear fault.
status light • Press Stop
• Cycle power
• Set [Fault Clear] to 1
• “Clear Faults” on the HIM
Diagnostic menu.
Incorrect input wiring. See page X for wiring None Wire inputs correctly and/or install
examples. jumper.
• 2 wire control requires Run, Run Forward,
Run Reverse or Jog input.
• 3 wire control requires Start and Stop
inputs.
• Jumper from terminal 25 to 26 is required.
Incorrect digital input programming. None Program [Digital Inx Sel] for correct
• Mutually exclusive choices have been inputs.
made (i.e., Jog and Jog Forward). Start or Run programming may be
• 2 wire and 3 wire programming may be missing.
conflicting. Flashing yellow Program [Digital Inx Sel] to resolve
• Exclusive functions (i.e, direction control) status light and conflicts.
may have multiple inputs configured. “DigIn CflctB” Remove multiple selections for the
• Stop is factory default and is not wired. indication on same function.
LCD HIM. Install stop button to apply a signal at
[Drive Status 2] stop terminal.
shows type 2
alarm(s).
Notes:
Specifications
Category PowerFlex 755
Certifications Listed to UL508C and CAN/CSA-C22.2 No. 14-05.
Category Specification
Protection Drive 380/400 480V 500V 600V 690V
AC Input Overvoltage Trip: 576V AC 576V AC
AC Input Undervoltage Trip: 250V AC 300V AC
Bus Overvoltage Trip: 815V DC 815V DC
Bus Undervoltage Shutoff: 200V DC 200V DC
Nominal Bus Voltage (Full Load): 540V DC 648V DC
Drive Overcurrent Trip
Software Overcurrent Trip: Calculated value, 105% of motor rated to 200% of drive rated
Hardware Overcurrent Trip: 105% of 3 sec. rating (158…210%)
Instantaneous Current Limit: 143% of 3 sec. rating (215…287%)
Line transients: up to 6000 volts peak per IEEE C62.41-1991
Control Logic Noise Immunity: Showering arc transients up to 1500V peak
Power Ride-Thru: 15 milliseconds at full load
Logic Control Ride-Thru: 0.5 seconds minimum, 2 seconds typical
Ground Fault Trip: Phase-to-ground on drive output
Short Circuit Trip: Phase-to-phase on drive output
Category Specification
Environment Altitude: 1000 m (3300 ft) max. without derating
Maximum Surrounding Air
Temperature without De-rating
IP20, NEMA/UL Open Type: 0…50° C (32…122° F) Frames 2…5, All Ratings
IP00, NEMA/UL Open Type: 0…50° C (32…122° F) Frames 6…7, All Ratings
IP20, NEMA/UL Type 1 (w/Hood): 0…40° C (32…104° F) Frames 2…5, All Ratings
IP20, NEMA/UL Type 1 (w/Label): 0…40° C (32…104° F) Frames 6…7, All Ratings
Flange Mount –
Front:
IP20, NEMA/UL Open Type: 0…50° C (32…122° F) Frames 2…5, All Ratings
IP00, NEMA/UL Open Type: 0…50° C (32…122° F) Frames 6…7, All Ratings
Back/Heat Sink:
IP66, NEMA/UL Type 4X 0…40° C (32…104° F) All Frames, All Ratings
Stand-alone/Wall Mount –
IP54, NEMA/UL Type 12 0…40° C (32…104° F) Frames 2…5, All Ratings
Storage Temperature (all const.): –40 to 70° C (–40 to 158° F)
Atmosphere: Important: Drive must not be installed in an area where the
ambient atmosphere contains volatile or corrosive gas,
vapors or dust. If the drive is not going to be installed for a
period of time, it must be stored in an area where it will not be
exposed to a corrosive atmosphere.
Relative Humidity: 5…95% non-condensing
Shock - Operating Frame 2…6: 15 g peak for 11 ms duration (±1.0 ms)
Frame 7: 10 g peak for 11 ms duration (±1.0 ms)
Shock - Packaged for Shipment Frame 2: 381 mm (15 in) drop height
Frame 3…4: 330 mm (13 in) drop height
Frame 5: 305 mm (12 in) drop height
Frame 6…7: Meets International Safe Transit Association
(ISTA) test procedure 2B
Vibration - Operating Frame 2: 1.000 mm (0.040 in.) displacement, 2 g peak
Frame 3…5: 1.000 mm (0.040 in.) displacement, 1.5 g
peak
Vibration - Packaged for Shipment Frame 6…7: 1.000 mm (0.040 in.) displacement, 1 g peak
Sinusoidal Loose Load:
Frame 2…5: 20.0 mm (0.8 in.) peak to peak, 2…5.186 Hz;
1.1 g peak from 5.186…20 Hz
Random Secured: Frame 6…7 Meets ISTA 2B packaging standards
Frame 2…5: Frequency (Hz) PSD (g2/Hz)
1 0.00005
4 0.01
16 0.01
40 0.001
80 0.001
200 0.00001
Frame 6…7 Meets International Safe Transit Association
(ISTA) test procedure 2B
Sound: Frame Fan Speed Sound Note: Sound pressure
Level level is measured at 2
2 50 CFM 63 dB meters.
3 80 CFM 64 dB
4 160 CFM 72 dB
5 260 CFM 77 dB
6 252 CFM 73 dB
7 252 CFM 74 dB
Surrounding Environment
Pollution Degree
Pollution Degree 1 & 2: All enclosures acceptable.
Pollution Degree 3 & 4: Enclosure that meets or exceeds IP54, NEMA/UL Type 12
(See page A-5 for descriptions of required.
each pollution degree rating.)
Category Specification
Electrical AC Input Voltage Tolerance: See page C-1 for full power and operating range.
Frequency Tolerance: 47-63 Hz.
Input Phases: Three-phase input provides full rating for all drives.
Single-phase operation provides up to 50% of rated current.
DC Input Voltage Tolerance: –/+ 10% of Nominal Bus Voltage (above)
Displacement Power Factor: 0.98 across entire speed range.
Efficiency: 97.5% at rated amps, nominal line volts.
Maximum Short Circuit Rating: 200,000 Amps RMS symmetrical.
Actual Short Circuit Rating: Determined by AIC rating of installed fuse/circuit breaker.
Maximum Drive to Motor Power Recommended not greater than 2:1 ratio.
Ratio
Control Method: Sine coded PWM with programmable carrier frequency.
Ratings apply to all drives. The drive can be supplied as 6
pulse.
Carrier Frequency: Default Settings:
Drive Frames 2…4: 4 kHz
Drive Frames 5…7: 2 kHz
Settings:
2, 4, 8, 12 kHz
Output Voltage Range: 0 to rated motor voltage
Output Frequency Range: 0…325 Hz @ 2 kHz carrier
0…650 Hz @ 4 kHz carrier
Frequency Accuracy
Digital Input: Within ±0.01% of set output frequency.
Analog Input: Within ±0.4% of maximum output frequency.
Frequency Control: Speed regulation - with Slip Compensation
0.5% of base speed across 40:1 speed range
40:1 operating range
Speed Control: Speed regulation - without feedback
0.1% of base speed across 120:1 speed range
120:1 operating range
50 rad/sec bandwidth
Speed regulation - with feedback
0.001% of base speed across 100:1 speed range
1000:1 operating range
190 rad/sec bandwidth
Torque Regulation: Torque Regulation - without feedback
±5%, 600 rad/sec bandwidth
Torque Regulation - with feedback
±2%, 2500 rad/sec bandwidth
Selectable Motor Control: Standard V/Hz with full custom capability.
Sensorless Vector with full tuning.
Flux Vector with and without a feedback device.
Induction and Permanent magnet motor control.
Stop Modes: Multiple programmable stop modes including - Ramp, Coast,
DC-Brake, Ramp-to-Hold, Fast Braking, and Current Limit
Stop.
Accel/Decel: Two independently programmable accel and decel times.
Each time may be programmed from 0 to 3600 seconds in
0.1 second increments.
S Curve Time Adjustable from 0 to 100% of ramp time (normal duty rating).
Intermittent Overload: 110% Overload capability for up to 1 minute
150% Overload capability for up to 3 seconds
Current Limit Capability: Proactive Current Limit programmable from 20 to 160% of
rated output current. Independently programmable
proportional and integral gain.
Electronic Motor Overload Class 10 protection with speed sensitive response. Complies
Protection: with N.E.C. Article 430. U.L. File E59272, volume 12.
Watts Loss
Table A.A 400 Volt Ratings - Watts Loss
Frame (1) kW External Watts Internal Watts Total Watts
2 7.5 184 43 227
11 261 50 311
3 15 340 67 407
18.5 411 79 490
22 558 91 649
4 30 751 98 849
37 952 118 1070
5 45 934 137 1071
55 1024 151 1175
6 75 1649 283 1932
90 1820 266 2086
110 2441 356 2797
132 2727 454 3181
7 160 2863 417 3280
200 3692 548 4240
250 4391 713 5104
(1) Enclosure code N only.
Output Devices Common mode cores are internal to the drive. For information on output
devices such as output contactors, cable terminators and output reactors
refer to the PowerFlex 750 Reference Manual.
Drive, Fuse & Circuit Table A.F provides drive ratings (including continuous, 1 minute and
Breaker Ratings peak(1)) and recommended AC line input fuse and circuit breaker
information. Sizes listed are the recommended sizes based on 40 degree C
and the U.S. N.E.C. Other country, state or local codes may require different
ratings.
Fusing
If fuses are chosen as the desired protection method, refer to the
recommended types listed below. If available amp ratings do not match the
tables provided, the closest fuse rating that exceeds the drive rating should
be chosen.
• IEC – BS88 (British Standard) Parts 1 & 2 (2), EN60269-1, Parts 1 & 2,
type gG or equivalent should be used.
• UL – UL Class T, J or L must be used.
Circuit Breakers
The “non-fuse” listings in the following tables include both circuit breakers
(inverse time or instantaneous trip). If one of these is chosen as the desired
protection method, the following requirements apply.
• IEC and UL – Both types of devices are acceptable for IEC and UL
installations.
(1)
Peak duration is 2 Sec.for 755 and 3 Sec. for 755
(2) Typical designations include, but may not be limited to the following; Parts 1 & 2: AC, AD, BC, BD, CD, DD, ED, EFS, EF, FF, FG,
GF, GG, GH.
Drive Sized For Normal Drive Sized For Heavy Input Input DC Input
Duty Duty Quantities AC Input Protection Devices Quantities Protection
Output Output Dual Element Circuit Motor
Continuous Catalog Overload Catalog Overload Continuous Time Delay Non-Time Breaker Circuit Continuous DC
Applied Output Number Amps Number Amps AC Input Fuse Delay Fuse Max Protector 140M Motor Starter with Adjustable Current Input Non-Time Delay
(3) (4) (6)
Frame (2)
Rating (1) Amps (x = F or G) 60 sec 3 sec (x = F or G) 60 sec 3 sec kVA Amps Min Max Min(3) Max(4) Size(5) Range (7) (8) kW Amps Fuse
400 Volt AC Input 540 Volt DC Input
5.5 kW 2 11.5 20x…C015 17.3 23.1 7.4 10.7 15 25 15 45 45 15 M-C2E-C16 M-D8E-C16 M-F8E-C16 6.8 12.6 HSJ20
7.5 kW 2 15.4 20x…C015 16.9 23.1 20x…C022 24.2 33.0 10.1 14.6 20 30 20 60 60 20 M-C2E-C20 M-D8E-C20 M-F8E-C20 9.2 17.0 HSJ25
11 kW 2 22 20x…C022 24.2 33.0 20x…C030 33.0 45.0 14.6 21.1 30 45 30 80 80 30 M-C2E-C25 M-D8E-C25 M-F8E-C25 13.3 24.6 HSJ40
15 kW 3 30 20x…C030 33.0 45.0 20x…C037 45.0 55.5 19.9 28.7 40 60 40 120 100 50 M-F8E-C32 18.1 33.6 HSJ50
18.5 kW 3 37 20x…C037 40.7 55.5 20x…C043 55.5 66.6 24.5 35.4 45 80 45 125 110 50 M-F8E-C45 22.3 41.4 HSJ70
22 kW 3 43 20x…C043 47.3 64.5 20x…C060 66.0 90.0 28.5 41.2 55 90 55 150 120 60 26.0 48.1 HSJ90
30 kW 4 60 20x…C060 66.0 90.0 20x…C072 90.0 108.0 39.8 57.4 75 125 75 225 180 100 36.2 67.1 HSJ100
45 kW 5 85 20x…C085 93.5 127.5 20x…C104 127.5 156.0 57.7 83.3 110 175 110 325 250 150 52.5 97.3 HSJ150
55 kW 5 104 20x…C104 114.4 156.0 20x…C140 156.0 210.0 71.3 102.9 130 225 130 400 300 150 64.9 120.2 HSJ175
75 kW 6 140 20x…C140 154.0 210.0 20x…C170 210.0 255.0 95.0 137.2 175 300 175 550 400 250 86.5 160.3 HSJ250
90 kW 6 170 20x…C170 187.0 255.0 20x…C205 255.0 307.5 115.4 166.5 225 375 225 600 500 250 105.1 194.6 HSJ350
110 kW 6 205 20x…C205 225.5 307.5 20x…C260 307.5 390.0 139.1 200.8 275 450 275 600 600 400 126.7 234.7 HSJ350
132 kW 6 260 20x…C260 286.0 390.0 20x…C302 390.0 468.0 176.5 254.7 325 575 325 750 700 400 160.7 297.7 HSJ400
160 kW 7 302 20x…C302 332.2 453.0 20x…C367 453.0 550.5 205.0 295.9 400 675 400 900 900 600 186.7 345.7 Bussman 170M6608
200 kW 7 367 20x…C367 403.7 550.5 20x…C456 550.5 684.0 249.1 359.5 475 800 475 1000 1100 600 226.9 420.2 Bussman 170M6612
250 kW 7 456 20x…C456 501.6 684.0 309.5 446.7 600 1000 600 1800 1300 600 281.9 522.0 Bussman 170M6613
480 Volt AC Input 650 Volt DC Input
7.5 Hp 2 11 20x…D011 20x…D014 16.5 21.0 7.9 9.5 15 20 15 40 40 15 M-C2E-C16 M-D8E-C16 M-F8E-C16 CMN-2500 7.2 11.1 HSJ20
10 Hp 2 14 20x…D014 15.4 21.0 20x…D022 24.2 33.0 10.4 12.5 17.5 30 17.5 55 50 20 M-C2E-C16 M-D8E-C16 M-F8E-C16 CMN-4000 9.5 14.7 HSJ30
15 Hp 2 22 20x…D022 24.2 33.0 20x…D027 33.0 40.5 16.6 19.9 30 50 30 80 80 30 M-C2E-C25 M-D8E-C25 M-F8E-C25 CMN-4000 15.1 23.3 HSJ40
20 Hp 3 27 20x…D027 29.7 40.5 20x…D034 40.5 51.0 20.6 24.8 35 60 35 100 100 50 M-F8E-C32 CMN-4000 18.8 28.9 HSJ50
25 Hp 3 34 20x…D034 37.4 51.0 20x…D040 51.0 61.2 25.9 31.2 45 75 45 125 100 50 M-F8E-C45 CMN-6300 23.6 36.4 HSJ60
30 Hp 3 40 20x…D040 44.0 60.0 20x…D052 60.0 78.0 30.5 36.7 50 90 50 150 120 50 M-F8E-C45 CMN-9000 27.8 42.9 HSJ80
40 Hp 4 52 20x…D052 57.2 78.0 20x…D065 78.0 97.5 39.7 47.7 65 110 65 200 150 70 CMN-9000 36.1 55.7 HSJ90
50 Hp 4 65 20x…D065 71.5 97.5 20x…D077 97.5 117.0 49.6 59.6 90 125 90 250 175 100 CMN-9000 45.1 69.7 HSJ100
60 Hp 5 77 20x…D077 84.7 115.5 20x…D096 115.5 144.0 60.1 72.3 100 170 100 300 225 100 54.7 84.5 HSJ150
75 Hp 5 96 20x…D096 105.6 144.0 20x…D125 144.0 187.5 74.9 90.1 125 200 125 375 275 125 68.3 105.3 HSJ175
100 Hp 6 125 20x…D125 137.5 187.5 20x…D156 187.5 234.0 97.6 117.4 175 275 175 500 375 250 88.9 137.1 HSJ200
125 Hp 6 156 20x…D156 171.6 234.0 20x…D186 234.0 280.8 121.8 146.5 200 350 200 600 450 250 110.9 171.2 HSJ300
150 Hp 6 186 20x…D186 204.6 279.0 20x…D248 279.0 372.0 145.2 174.6 250 400 250 600 550 250 132.2 204.1 HSJ400
200 Hp 6 248 20x…D248 272.8 372.0 20x…D302 372.0 453.0 193.6 232.8 325 550 325 700 700 400 176.3 272.1 HSJ400
250 Hp 7 302 20x…D302 332.2 453.0 20x…D361 453.0 543.6 235.7 283.5 400 675 400 900 900 600 214.7 331.3 Bussman 170M6608
300 Hp 7 361 20x…D361 397.1 541.5 20x…D415 541.5 649.8 281.8 338.9 475 800 475 1000 1000 600 256.6 396.1 Bussman 170M6612
350 Hp 7 415 20x…D415 456.5 622.5 323.9 389.6 525 900 525 1200 1200 600 295.0 455.3 Bussman 170M6612
Notes:
(1)
“Applied Rating” refers to the motor that will be connected to the drive. For example, a “C015 drive” can be used in Normal Duty mode on a 7.5 kW motor, or in Heavy Duty mode on a 5.5 kW motor. The drive can be
programmed for either mode. Wiring and fuses can be sized based on the programmed mode. For any given drive catalog number, Normal Duty mode provides higher continuous current but smaller overload current with
respect to Heavy Duty mode. See parameter 306 [Duty Rating].
(2)
Enclosure code N only.
(3)
Minimum protection device size is the lowest rated device that supplies maximum protection without nuisance tripping.
(4)
Maximum protection device size is the highest rated device that supplies drive protection. For US NEC, minimum size is 125% of motor FLA. Ratings shown are maximum.
(5)
Circuit Breaker - inverse time breaker. For US NEC, minimum size is 125% of motor FLA. Ratings shown are maximum.
(6) Recommended Motor circuit protector - Instantaneous trip circuit breaker. The trip setting should be set to the input current of the drive and should be sized for the continuous current of the system.
(7)
Bulletin 140M with adjustable current range should have the current trip set to the minimum range that the device will not trip.
(8)
Manual Self-Protected (Type E) Combination Motor Controller. 480Y/277V and 600Y/347V AC Input.
Supplemental Drive Information A-11
404.2
(15.91)
424.2
(16.70)
481.8
(18.97)
188.3 (7.41)
169.2 (6.66)
14x: Ø3.50
94.2 (3.71) (Ø0.138)
19.2 (0.76)
63.7
(2.51)
460.6
(18.13) 399.60 +1.80/-0.00
(15.7 +0.1/-0.0)
395.3
(15.56)
285.3
(11.23)
175.3
(6.90)
65.3
(2.57) 128.00 +1.80/-0.00 30.5
(5.0 +0.1/-0.0) (1.20)
30.2
(1.19)
528.2
(20.80)
543.2
(21.39)
207.0 (8.15)
173.0 (6.81)
135.0 (5.31)
97.0 (3.82)
63.0 (2.48)
187.0
(7.36) 170.8
(6.72) 136.5
(5.37)
435.0
(17.13)
454.0
(17.87)
515.0
(20.28)
240.5 (9.47)
208.3 (8.20)
16x: Ø3.50
120.3 (4.74) (Ø0.138)
32.3 (1.27)
84.6
495.5 (3.33)
(19.51)
457.8
(18.02)
247.8
(9.76)
142.8
(5.62) 4x: 5.00R
(0.197R)
37.8
(1.48) 179.00 +1.80/-0.00 30.75
(7.047 +0.070/-0.000) (1.211)
30.75
(1.211)
533.0
(20.98)
551.0
(21.69)
135.8 (5.35)
123.3 (4.85)
92.8 (3.65)
62.3 (2.45)
49.8 (1.96)
183.5
(7.22)
136.5
(5.37)
455.0
(17.91)
474.0
(18.66)
202.0
(7.95)
158.8 (6.25)
144.8 (5.70)
110.8 (4.36)
76.8 (3.02) 3x: Ø22.2
62.8 (2.47) (Ø0.87)
2x: Ø43.7
187.0 (Ø1.72)
(7.36)
168.7
(6.64)
118.7
(4.67)
535.0
(21.06)
272.50 (10.728)
224.25 (8.829)
16x: Ø3.50
136.25 (5.364) (Ø0.138)
48.25 (1.900)
84.5
(3.33)
515.50
(20.295)
477.75
(18.809)
454.00 +1.80/-0.00
367.75 (17.874 +0.070/-0.000)
(14.478)
257.75
(10.148)
147.75
(5.817) 4x: 5.00R
(0.197R)
37.75
(1.486) 211.00 +1.80/-0.00 30.75
(8.307 +0.070/-0.000) (1.211)
30.75
(1.211)
553.0
(21.77)
571.0
(22.48)
165.8 (6.53)
140.8 (5.54)
108.8 (4.28)
76.8 (3.02)
51.8 (2.04)
182.0
(7.17)
136.5
(5.37)
531.0
(20.91)
550.0
(21.65)
201.0 (7.91)
180.0 (7.09)
135.0 (5.31)
90.0 (3.54)
69.0 (2.72)
187.0
(7.36)
173.0
(6.81)
123.0
(4.84)
611.0
(24.06)
320.50 (12.618)
280.25 (11.033)
200.25 (7.884)
22x: Ø3.50
120.25 (4.734) (Ø0.138)
40.25 (1.585)
591.50
(23.287)
550.75
(21.683) 84.5
(3.33)
465.75
(18.337)
531.0 +1.8/-0.0
380.75 (20.91 +0.07/-0.00)
(14.990)
295.75
(11.644)
210.75
(8.297)
40.75
(1.604) 30.25
259.0 +1.8/-0.0 (1.191)
(10.20 +0.07/-0.00)
30.75
(1.211)
629.0
(24.76)
647.0
(25.47)
6.4
(0.25)
212.8 (8.38)
172.8 (6.80)
132.8 (5.23)
92.8 (3.65)
52.8 (2.08)
181.9
(7.16)
141.9
(5.59)
665.5 644.0
(26.20) (25.35)
6.4 (0.25)
283.0
(11.14) ø14.5 (0.57)
254.0
(10.00)
ø6.5 (0.26)
14.5 (0.57)
609.0
(23.98)
623.0
(24.53)
665.5
(26.20)
284.0 (11.18)
258.0 (10.16)
225.5 (8.88)
193.0 (7.60)
91.0 (3.58)
58.5 (2.30)
26.0 (1.02) 24x: Ø6.4
(Ø0.25)
624.0
(24.57)
600.0
(23.62)
562.0
(22.13)
362.0
(14.25)
262.0
(10.31)
162.0
(6.38)
62.0
(2.44) 268.0 +2.0/-1.5 31.5
24.0 (10.60 +0.08/-0.06) (1.24)
(0.94) 8.0
(0.30)
875.0
875.0 (34.45)
(34.45)
8.5 (0.33)
380.0
(14.96)
330.0
(12.99)
ø16.0 (0.63)
ø8.5 (0.33)
25.0 (0.98)
825.0
(32.48)
838.0
(32.99)
875.0
(34.45)
138.0
(5.43)
403.00 (15.87)
352.63 (13.88)
251.88 (9.92) 32x: Ø6.0
(Ø0.24)
151.13 (5.95)
50.38 (1.98)
812.0
(31.97)
784.0
(30.87)
744.8
(29.32)
666.4
(26.24)
768.0
(30.24)
588.0
(23.15)
509.6
(20.06)
431.2
(16.98)
352.8
(13.89)
274.4
(10.80)
196.0
(7.72)
117.6
(4.63)
39.2
(1.54)
28.0 387.0 8.0
(1.10) (15.24) (0.31)
8.0
(0.31)
List of Control Block Flow diagrams on the following pages illustrate the drives control
Diagrams algorithms.
For Information on … See Page...
Flux Vector Overview B-3
VF, SV Overview B-4
Speed/Position Feedback B-5
Speed Control - Reference Overview B-6
Speed Control - Reference (1) B-7
Speed Control - Reference (2) B-8
Speed Control - Reference (3) B-9
Speed Control - Reference (4) B-10
Speed Control - Reference (5) B-11
Speed Control - Regulator (FOC) B-12
Position Control - Reference B-13
Position Control - Regulator B-14
Position Control - Aux Function B-15
Position Control - Phase Locked Loop B-16
Position Control - Position CAM B-17
Position Control - Profiler/Indexer B-18
Position Control - Homing B-19
Torque Control - Overview B-20
Torque Control - Reference Scale & Trim B-21
Torque Control - Torque B-22
Torque Comtrol - Current B-23
Torque Control - Inertia Adaption B-24
Torque Control - Load Observer / Estimator B-25
Process Control (1) B-26
Process Control (2) B-27
MOP Control B-28
Inputs & Outputs - Digital B-29
Inputs & Outputs - Analog B-30
Control Logic B-31
Inverter Overload IT B-32
Diagnostic Tools B-33
Symbol Legend: (1) These diagrams are for reference only and may
Drive Option Module Requires port number. not accurately reflect all logical control signals;
Parameters Parameters
actual functionality is implied by the approximated
Read Only Parameter diagrams. Accuracy of these diagrams is not
guaranteed.
Read / Write Parameter
( ) = Enumerated Parameter
[ ] = Page and Coordinate
ex. 3A2 = pg 3, Column A, Row 2
= Constant value
( Speed FF Ref )
( Spd Profiler Out ) ( Spd Reg Out )
PID LP
PID Prop Gain 1086 1084
Filter BW
PID LP
PID Prop Gain 1086 1084
Filter BW
Source Processing
Parameter
Selection
Alternate
d 1
Velocity Fdbk
Processing dt
Derivative
4
Psn Fdbk
Mtr Psn
Slip RPM at FLA Virtual Enc EPR To Posit Ref,
Fdbk 847
621 141 Source Posit Reg
VF or SV &
Parameter [11C5], [12A4], [12A5]
Final Speed Ref Open Loop Open Loop Fdbk Selection
Open Loop
From Spd Ref 597 Virtual Encoder
137 Mtr Psn Fdbk Sel 135
[9D3] Total Inertia Virtual Enc EPR
Control Mode/ 76 1
141 [9I4] Aux Vel FdbkFltr
Feedback Mode
Output Frequency
133
5 ***INTERNAL CONDITION ONLY***
5
Simulator Fdbk
Torque Cur Fdbk Aux Vel Feedback
Motor Simulator Aux Velocity
Virtual Encoder
138 Aux Vel
Fdbk Fdbk 134 To Spd Ref
Source Processing [5A3]
Limited Trq Ref Parameter
Selection
From Torq Ctrl Current 690
Control Block Diagrams
A B C D E F G H I
1 Spd Ref
Speed Control – Reference Overview
Command
Profiling/ Limited
Spd Ref B Jogging/
Selected Spd Ref Direction Limit Spd Ref Speed Ref
2 Lift App/ Skip
Ref B Switch Stop / Torque
+ Autotune/ Mode Bands
Trim Ref B Auto Control Proving
Homing/
+ Overrides Limit
Trim % Ref B
From
PI Regulator
Presets 3-7 Auto (Exclusive Mode)
DPI Ports 1-6 Manual
ENet Spd Ref
Speed Control - Reference Overview
3
Inertia Inertia Comp
Vector Speed Control Comp Torque Ref
Virtual
Encoder
Speed
Comp
Rate
Select From Pos Reg
Position Output
Regulator Filter
V/F Speed Control
Ramped
VF or SV Linear Speed Ref
5 Ramp & Frequency
S Curve Ref
Limit Limit
V/F Ramp S-Curve
Max Speeds Max Speed +
Droop From Overspeed Limit
Velocity Trim
Regulator Speed
From Status
PI Regulator Speed Feedback Status
From
(Trim Mode) Slip Comp Vector Ramp Status
6 F/F Ramp Status
872 872
MOP Reference 558 Port 3 Reference 873 Port 3 Reference 873 3
573 ( Preset3 Auto )
[26F3]
Parameter Port 4 Reference 874 Port 4 Reference 874
Aux Vel Feedback 4
134 Selection 574 ( Preset4 Auto )
[3H5] Port 5 Reference 875 Port 5 Reference 875
3 Parameter Parameter
Port 6 Reference 876 Selection Port 6 Reference 876 Selection 5
Default 575 ( Preset5 Auto )
Port 1 Reference 871
Port 2 Reference 872 6
Anlg In1 PortVal Anlg In1 PortVal 576 ( Preset6 Auto )
Port 3 Reference 873 (option port) (option port)
7
577 ( Preset7 Auto )
Port 4 Reference 874 Anlg In2 PortVal Anlg In2 PortVal
(option port) (option port) 17
Port 5 Reference 875 871 ( DPI Prt1 Man )
Port 6 Reference 876
TrmPct RefA AnHi 610 * Trim RefA AnlgHi 602 * ( DPI Prt2 Man )
18
872
Option Ports:
TrmPct RefA AnLo 611 Trim RefA AnlgLo 603
4 Analog, EtherNet, 19
873 ( DPI Prt3 Man )
DeviceLogix
* x x + ( DPI Prt4 Man )
20
Spd Ref A AnlgHi 547 874
Spd Ref A AnlgLo 548 Speed Ref A Mult 21
875 ( DPI Prt5 Man )
549
22
876 ( DPI Prt6 Man )
A B C D E F G H I
Position Control
1 [20D5] Actv SpTqPs Mode (Add Spd Ref)
Speed Control – Reference (2)
313 721 10 Selected Spd
From
Position
Direction Mode Control Autotune Control Limit Switch Control Speed Ref Limits
At Limit Status
Max Speed Limit (MaxSpeed Lmt)
945 2
Spd Ref After
X Final Limit
5 PI Speed Trim 555 Position Reg Output [8A2]
Limit
Spd Ref Scale Max Fwd Speed 520
From 2 0 PsnReg Spd Out
1093 0 Max Rev Speed 521
Process Ctrl From Posit Reg 843
[25E3] PID Output Meter ≠2 1 [12I5]
0 0 1
0
1079 935 17
Control Block Diagrams
935 17
PID Output Sel Drive Status 1
(Speed Trim) (Jogging) Drive Status 1
6
(Jogging)
A B C D E F G H I
Commanded
Control Block Diagrams
SpdRef
Speed Control – Reference (4)
1 Start/Stop
2 VF (V/Hz), SV
Drive Status 1
(Running) V/F Ramp and Rate Select
0,1
Decel Time 2 538
Drive Logic Rslt
[29H3] 879 10 11
(Decel Time 1, 2)
Jog Acc Dec Time 539
3 S Curve Accel, Decel 540 541
Speed Control
Max Speed
Limits
4
Spd Ref After
Final Limit
Limit [8A2]
From 2 0
1093
Process Ctrl
[25E3] PID Output Meter ≠2 1
0 0
5
1079 935 17
PID Output Sel Drive Status 1
(Speed Trim) (Jogging)
594
At Limit Status
Ramped Spd Ref Limit (MaxSpeed Lmt) Final Speed Ref (Max Fwd/Rev +
[8G2] Overspeed Limit)
Max Fwd/Rev To Fdbk
Speed Limit OR 945 2 597 Speed Limit Limited
Limited
Speed Control - Reference (5)
VF or SV [3B5]
Speed Adder Freq Adder
(0-2,4,5,7,8)
(Hz)
X
621 Slip RPM at FLA
Limit Limit
At Limit Status
3 Filtered (100 R/S) 1.5
Iq Feedback (pu) 945 3 (OverSpd Lmt)
RPM Hz X X Hz RPM
1 1 *Poles Speed to Freq Output
RPM Hz [NP Freq] [NP Spd]*Poles
Scaling Selected Frequency
[NP Spd] [NP Freq] 120 120
1 1 *Poles Freq Ref Freq Integral
(Hz) 1
[NP Spd] [NP Freq] 120 (Hz)
620 Droop RPM at FLA Ramp Input X
Ramp Rate
Bus/Current
[8E2]
(Motor Ctrl Limiter [3D5],
VHzSV Spd Reg Kp Interrupt) (Freq Ramp) [24E4],
663 (Hz / Sec) Limit Limit [24H3]
4 Ramp Rate
X
Speed Fdbk VHzSV [8I1]
Active Vel Fdbk with Sensor SpdTrimReg Interrupt Time
0
From Fdbk 131 PI 623 Scaling
[3F2] Motor
Limit Freq
664 Motor Freq 1 (Hz)
To Ramp Integrator Speed to Freq Scaling
VHzSV Spd Reg Ki
Slip Comp BW 622 [8G1]
VF, SV Speed Regulator
Open Loop
Iq Feedback (pu) LPF Speed Fdbk
5 Freq Limit High (Hz)
1 Freq Limit Low (Hz)
X Previous Reverse
RPM Ramped Spd Ref Prevention
Hz
Slip RPM at FLA Speed Sensor Type [8I2]
1 1 *Poles
621 ***INTERNAL CONDITION ONLY***
[NP Spd] [NP Freq] 120
(Max Fwd/Rev +
Overspeed Limit)
Freq Limit
Control Block Diagrams
A B C D E F G H I
Control Block Diagrams
76 Total Inertia
InAdp LdObs Mode
2 704
0,2
Preset
5 SReg Trq Preset 652
[20E2]
Selected Trq Ref 685
Other Ref
767 Psn PLL 9
Sources
6 Psn Direct Ref
A B C D E F G H I
Psn Selected
1 Ref
Σ Psn Command Position Control – Regulator
From [N]
722 + Σ 723
Posit Ref [D] +
1
Position Control – Aux Functions
PsnWatch1 Stpt 747 Psn Reg Status PsnWatch2 Stpt 750 Psn Reg Status
Position Control - Aux Function
In Position Detect
In Position Detect
In Pos Psn Band 726
In Pos Psn Dwell 727
5
Control Block Diagrams
A B C D E F G H I
Control Block Diagrams
1 Velocity FF
2 Ext Vel FF
Selection LPF
801
3 0 Delay 807 PLL Speed Out
PLL Ext Spd Sel 796 0 [11F5]
1
808 PLL Speed OutAdv
X to V [11F5]
Conv 0
0
Delay 809 PLL Enc Out
PLL Psn Stpt 800 [11F5]
+ 1
+ Loop + VE 810 PLL Enc Out Adv
Other Ref - Filter [11F5]
Sources Parameter 0
Selection
0
4
806 PLL Psn Out Fltr
PLL Psn Ref Sel 799
EGR
[ ]
[ ]
803 PLL Virt Enc RPM
5
PLL EPR Input 804 X X
Y-span
Unwind X 1472 PCAM Vel Out
Position Control - Position CAM
Cndtnl Hold 12
6
A B C D E F G H I
Control Block Diagrams
1
Position Control – Profiler/Indexer (1)
Step Step Step Step Step Step
1 2 3 4 15 16
[11E2]
Position Control - Profiler/Indexer
Next Step Position > N/A N/A N/A DigIn Position > Restart PTP
Condition Value transition Value Indexer User Home Psn 738 Position Command
DigIn # N/A N/A N/A N/A Digin # N/A N/A
784
[11E2]
Type = Position Incremental (Posit Incr)
Action Posit Blend Time Param Digin (+/-) Wait Step to Next End
3 Blend Blend Blend Digin
Velocity Move vel N/A N/A N/A Move vel Move vel N/A
Accel Move accel N/A N/A N/A Move accel Move accel N/A Homing Control Homing Status
Decel Move decel N/A N/A N/A Move decel Move decel N/A
731 0 Find Home 730 0 Home Request 737 Actual Home Psn
Value Incremental N/A N/A N/A Incremental Incremental N/A
Target pos Target pos Target pos Home DI Home Enabled
1 1
Dwell N/A N/A N/A N/A Dwell Time Dwell Time Dwell
Time 2 Home Marker 2 Homing
Batch N/A N/A N/A N/A Batch # Batch # N/A
Next Next Step N/A N/A N/A Next Step Next Step N/A 3 Return Home 3 At Home
Next Step Position > N/A N/A N/A DigIn Position > Restart
Condition Value transition Value Indexer 4 Psn Redefine
DigIn # N/A N/A N/A N/A Digin # N/A N/A
5 Homing Alarm
4 6 Home DI Inv
Type = Speed Profile 7 Hold At Home
Action Posit Blend Time Blend Param Blend Digin Blend (+/-) Wait Step to Next End
Digin
Velocity Move vel Move vel Move vel Move Vel Move vel Move vel N/A
Accel Move accel Move accel Move accel Move accel Move accel Move accel N/A
Decel Move decel Move decel Move decel Move decel Move decel Move decel N/A
732 DI Find Home
Value Incremental Total Time Compare N/A Total Time Total Time N/A 733 DI Redefine Psn
Target pos Param # (+/-)
Dwell N/A N/A Compare Dwell Time Dwell Time Dwell Time Dwell 734 DI OL Home Limit
Param # Time
Batch N/A N/A N/A Batch # Batch # Batch # N/A
Next Next Step Next Step Next Step Next Step Next Step Next Step N/A
Next Step Position > Time > Param[Value] Digin [Value] Digin Time > Restart
Condition Value Value Compare to transition transition Value Profile
5 Param[Dwell]
DigIn # N/A N/A N/A Digin # Digin # N/A N/A
Control Block Diagrams
A B C D E F G H I
Control Block Diagrams
1
Torque Control - Overview
Speed /
Filtered
Te
Torque Control - Overview
Torq Ref 1
Torque
3
Reference
Torq Ref 2 Scale Load
and Observer/
Torq Trim Estimator
Trim
0.0 ( Disabled )
0.0 ( Disabled )
Trq Ref A Stpt
676 ( Setpoint ) Default
Other
Trq Ref A Mult 679 x
3
0
Control Block Diagrams
A B C D E F G H I
InertiaTrqAdd
Control Block Diagrams
+ 0 0 - To Torq Ctrl
From Spd Reg 660 + 685 + + 689
+ II + Current
[10I3] Torq Reg 2 R
SReg Output 1 [10D5] [21B2],
Notch
[22D2],
SLAT
Min 3 1 [23D2]
Min
Notch Fltr Freq 687
Torque
SLAT 686 Notch Fltr Atten 688
3 Max
Step
4
Max
Load
Sum 5 Estimate
[23C5] 707
+
Commanded Trq + Load
Observer
From Torq Ref 4 Load
Profiler 6 2
[19H4] Total Inertia 76
Observer/
Motor Acceleration Disabled
Psn P2P 7 Estimator 0
Feedback 0
4
Psn Camming 8
Load Observer BW 711
[6D2], 704
Psn PLL 9 [10D5],
[11D2], InAdp LdObs Mode
Psn Direct 10 [11I1],
[12H5],
[16H2]
Neg Pos
Active Vel Fdbk Flux Limit Limit 425
From Fdbk 131 Active Neg Active Pos
Torque Limit Torque Limit Current Rate Lmt
[3F2]
Regen Power Limit 426 1
{Regen PwrLmt} Max
-1 Flux
3
Bus + Pwr
{BusVltgFVLmt} + -1
Regulator Te
Calc
1
Min
Motor Power Lmt Flux
427
{Mtrng PwrLmt}
5
Current Lmt Sel 421
Power VF or SV
Current Limit 1 422 Thermal Mgr Current Limit (0-2,4,5,7,8)
Unit
424 Active Cur Lmt
Thermal
Current Limit 2 423
Parameter Protection [30D2]
Selection
Control Block Diagrams
A B C D E F G H I
Control Block Diagrams
1
Torque Control – Inertia Adaption
Limit IA LdObs 1
System Model
Delay
Pos Torque Limit 670
709
Neg Torque Limit 671 d
3
FIR
Position dt
Alternate Filter Velocity Accel
Encoder Derivative
Inertia Adaption
1
Torque Control – Load Observer / Estimator
Filtered Limited
Trq Ref Drive Status 2
Trq Ref [20E2]
(FdbkLoss Sw0)
Torque
[20H2] 689 690 936 5 [3E1]
Limits
1 Position
d
Notch Filter Primary FIR 0
Encoder dt
Output Total Inertia Filter Velocity Accel
Derivative
Limit IA LdObs 1
3 System Model
Torque Control - Load Observer / Estimator
Delay
Pos Torque Limit 670
709
Neg Torque Limit 671 d
FIR
Position dt
Alternate Filter Velocity Accel
Encoder Derivative
Load Observer BW
InAdp LdObs Mode
711 Speed Sensor
704 Type
Load Motor Acceleration Feedback
4 2
Observer Else
X From Fdbk
Filter
Else
[3E3]
LPass 1
0 0
Sensorless
Load 10 R/S 76
Estimate
Total Inertia
707
Filter
[20G3] LPass
5
A B C D E F G H I
Control Block Diagrams
Parameter
Selection
MOP Reference
4 [26F2] Float Types
558
0 0
2 1065
936 10
PID Cfg
(Zero Clamp) Drive Status 2
Control Block Diagrams
(PID FB Loss)
6 [24C4]
A B C D E F G H I
Control Block Diagrams
1
MOP Control
Option Port:
MOP Control
0 0 1
4 559 1 933 4
Save MOP Ref Start Inhibits
(At Stop) (Stop)
0 0 1
559 0 933 3
Save MOP Ref Start Inhibits
(At Pwr Down) (Precharge)
5
Outputs
Dig Out0 0
Timer Common
Source
Inputs Parameter 1
Selection Inv
NO
10 14
Dig In Sts
2 RO0 Sel RO0 On Time
1 5 4 3 2 1 0
5 1
6 1 NC
Dig Out1 0
Timer
Source
Input 4 Parameter Common
1
Selection Inv OR
3 20 24
NO
RO1/TO0 Sel RO1/TO0 On Time
Input 3
*-1R2T (1-Relay / 2-Transistor) I/O Modules Only
Dig Out2 0
Timer Common
4 Source
Parameter 1
Selection Inv
Input 1 NO
30 34
Output Compare
Input 0
RO0 Level Sel RO1/TO0 Level Sel *-1R2T (1-Relay / 2-Transistor) I/O Modules Only
A B C D E F G H I
Inputs
Control Block Diagrams
5
Flt CL Stop
Hold 6 Outputs
Input
Anlg Out0 Val
7
Set Input Lo 82
3
8 Anlg Out0 DataHi V/mA
Set Input Hi
Anlg Out0 Data 78 Anlg Out0 Hi Analog Out Type Voltage
77 80 70 0 +
V/mA
1
Note: Control Logic
The following parameters are typically referenced
0 when configuring or monitoring Control Logic;
P933 [Start Inhibits]
Digital Inputs
15
0
DPI Port 1
Control Logic
15
0
888 Write Mask Cfg
DPI Port 2
Logic Parser To Spd Ref
15 [5G2], [6E3], [7F2],
0 [7F3], [8F2], [8F3]
Drive Logic Rslt
DPI Port 3
3 879
15
0 0
Mask Evaluation
DPI Port 4 Owner Logic Logic Evaluation
Logic
15 31
0
DPI Port 5
4 15
0
DPI Port 6
15 Bit Bit
0 Masks Owners
Masks Act Status 00 Stop 16 Coast Stop
01 Start 17 CLimit Stop
Embedded Ethernet 02 Jog 1 18 Run
Slot 13 03 Clear Faults 19 Jog 2
04 Forward 20 Reserved
15 05 Reverse 21 Reserved
5 919 Stop Owner 06 Manual 22 Reserved
0 324 Logic Mask 885 Port Mask Act 07 Reserved 23 Reserved
325 Auto Mask 886 Logic Mask Act 920 Start Owner 08 Accel Time 1 24 Reserved
DeviceLogix 326 Manual Cmd Mask 887 Write Mask Act 921 Jog Owner 09 Accel Time 2 25 Reserved
Slot 14 327 Manual Ref Mask 922 Dir Owner 10 Decel Time 1 26 Reserved
923 Clear Flt Owner 11 Decel Time 2 27 Reserved
15 12 SpdRef Sel 0 28 Reserved
924 Manual Owner 13 SpdRef Sel 1 29 Reserved
925 Ref Select Owner 14 SpdRef Sel 2 30 Reserved
15 Reserved 31 Reserved
Control Block Diagrams
A B C D E F G H I
Control Block Diagrams
Output Current 7
Alarm Status B
960 0 IGBT OT
Current Limit 1 422
1 Heatsink OT
Current Limit 2 423
4 Drive OL
Parameter
Other Ref Sources Selection 5 CurLmt Reduc
3
6 PWMFrq Reduc
4 TransistorOT Motor
Current
5 SinkUnderTmp 416 MtrOL Reset Time
Motor OL Actn 410
6 Excess Load
Mtr OL at Pwr Up 411 418 Mtr OL Counts
4 DB resistor
Bus Reg Mode A 372
Mtr OL Alarm Lvl 412 150% right of curve
Bus Reg Mode B 373 419 Motor OL Trip Time
Mtr OL Reset Lvl 415
12 DC Bus Memory
dc bus 102%
Bus Reg Lvl Cfg 374
60 (Hot) time (sec)
Bus Reg Level 375
Motor 180 (Cold)
Current
Bus Reg Ki 380
Bus Reg Kp 381 Alarm Status A
Motor OL Factor 413 1.0 - 2.0 959 2 Motor OL
X (1.025 Typ)
5 Motor NP Amps 26
Bus Limit Kp 376 *
50% Fault Status A
Bus Limit Kd 377
Bus Limit ACR Ki 378 952 2 Motor OL
Diagnostic Tools
1 Peak Detect Numeric Constants
NOTE: 1035 PkDtct Stpt Real
The change bit, Peak x Chng (where x = 1 or 2), is set TRUE if the
peak detect value changes, else the change bit is set FALSE. 1036 PkDtct Stpt Dint
Change is also set to FALSE if the detector is in HOLD or SET.
Bit
Digital Switches Bit Peak1 Cfg
Source Bit To Numeric Conversion 1039 2
Source (Peak1 Set)
Dig Sw Parameter Dig Sw Parameter
Peak1 Cfg Peak1 Cfg
d57 d61 1039 0 1039 1
Real Sel Selection Dint Sel Selection (Peak1 Peak) (Peak1 Hold)
Dig Sw Real Out Dig Sw Dint Out PeakDetect1 Out
1 1 PkDtct1 In Sel
Sw On Stpt Real d59 d60 Sw On Stpt Dint d63 d64 on 1041
1037
2 0 0 off
Sw Off Stpt Real d58 Sw Off Stpt Dint d62 Peak 1 PkDtct1
Diagnostic Tools
from 0 to [+ d42]
d56 Trend State: 1=Enable Wait, 2=First Scan, 3=PreTrigger, 4=PostTrigger, 5=Disable Wait
6
‘d’ Prefix Refers to Diagnostic Item Number (ex. d33) – Reference Symbol Legend
Notes:
Application Notes
Voltage Tolerance Nominal Line Nominal Motor Drive Full Power Drive Operating
Drive Rating Voltage Voltage Range Range
380…400 380 380 380…528 342…528
400 400 400…528
480 460 460…528
Drive Full Power Range = Nominal Motor Voltage to Drive Rated Voltage + 10%.
Rated current is available across the entire Drive Full Power Range
Drive Operating Range = Lowest Nominal Motor Voltage - 10% to Drive Rated Voltage + 10%.
Drive Output is linearly derated when Actual Line Voltage is less than
the Nominal Motor Voltage
HP @ Motor (Drive Output)
Example:
At 342V Actual Line Voltage, the maximum power the 5 HP, 460V motor
can produce is 3.7 HP at 44.6 Hz.
5 HP
HP @ Motor (Drive Output)
3.7 HP
No Drive
Output
342V 480V
460V 528V
Actual Line Voltage (Drive Input)
Three-Phase
AC Input
(Input Contactor) M
R (L1)
S (L2)
T (L3)
Complete information about using the HIM to configure and monitor your
drive is provided in the Enhanced PowerFlex 7-Class Human Interface
Module (HIM) User Manual, publication 20HIM-UM001.
LCD Display Elements The HIM display is divided into three zones:
➊ Status Bar
➋ Data Area
➌ Soft Key Labels
Stopped AUTO
0.00 Hz F ➊
Host Drive
240V 4.2A ➋
Rev 3.002 Ser. A
00
ESC REF TEXT PAR# ➌
Status Bar The Status Bar provides information about the operating condition of the
Host Drive.
Figure D.2 Status Bar on the Display Screen
Stopped AUTO
0.00 Hz F
Element Description
Host Icon A small image of the connected Host Drive.
Soft Keys Up to five dynamic soft keys (shown shaded in Figure D.3) may be
available. A soft key changes its function/name based on the HIM screen or
data entry mode. When a soft key is active, its present function is shown on
the LCD screen in its corresponding Soft Key Label (item 3 in Figure D.1).
Figure D.3 Soft Keys
Navigation and Number The five blue multi-function keys shown in Figure D.4 are used to scroll
Keys menus/screens, perform corresponding functions displayed in the Data Area
(item 2 in Figure D.1) or enter numeric values. The five gray number keys
(0, 1, 3, 7, and 9) are used only to enter their respective numeric value
Figure D.4 Navigation and Number Keys.
Single Function Keys Each of the four single-function keys shown in Figure D.5 always performs
only its dedicated function.
Figure D.5 Single Function Keys
Control Bar Access jog, direction, auto/manual, and other control functions.
Navigate to Start-Up Menu 1. To access the Start-Up menu after the initial drive power-up, apply
Using the HIM power to the drive.
Upon a subsequent power up, the Status screen for Port 00 (Host Drive)
is shown by default.
Figure D.6 Status Screen
Stopped AUTO
0.00 Hz F
Host Drive
240V 4.2A
Rev 3.002 Ser. A
00
ESC REF PAR# TEXT
Stopped AUTO
0.00 Hz F
DEV PARAM
Linear List
File-Group
00 Changed Params
ESC
Stopped AUTO
0.00 Hz F
START UP
Begin Start Up
Continue Start Up
00
ESC
When the drive is powered up, the Status screen for Port 00 (Host Drive)
is shown by default.
Figure D.9 Status Screen Displaying Port 00 (Host Drive)
Stopped AUTO
0.00 Hz F
Host Drive
240V 4.2A
Rev 3.002 Ser. A
00
ESC REF PAR# TEXT
Stopped AUTO
0.00 Hz F
20-HIM-x6
LCD HIM
Operational
01
ESC REF PAR# TEXT
3. Press the PAR# soft key or the (Folders) key to access parameters.
2. Use the or key to scroll to the Port 00 for the Host Drive
whose settings you want to reset to factory defaults.
6. Press the (Enter) key to display the Set Defaults pop-up box.
Figure D.11 Set Defaults Pop-Up Box for PowerFlex 750-Series Drives
Stopped AUTO
0.00 Hz F
Port 00: Set Defaults
Host and Ports (Preferred)
This Port Only
ESC INFO
– Host and Ports (Preferred): Selects the Host device and all ports for a
factory default action.
– This Port Only: Selects only this port for a factory default action.
TIP: For a description of a selected menu item, press the INFO soft key.
8. Press the (Enter) key to display the warning pop-up box to reset
defaults.
Figure D.12 Host and Ports (Preferred) Figure D.13 This Port Only Pop-Up
Pop-Up Box Box
Press the ENTER soft key to affirm and set most Press the MOST soft key to set MOST settings
parameters for the Host Drive and port devices to for the selected port device to factory defaults.
factory defaults. In this case, refer to the Host In this case, refer to the Host Drive User
Drive and port device User Manuals for the Manual for the settings that will NOT be
settings that will NOT be restored. Or press the restored. Press the ALL soft key to set ALL
ESC soft key to cancel. settings for the selected port device to factory
defaults. Or press the ESC soft key to cancel.
6. Press the (Enter) key to display the Set Defaults pop-up box.
Figure D.14 Set Defaults Pop-Up Box for PowerFlex 750-Series Peripherals
Stopped AUTO
0.00 Hz F
Port xx: Set Defaults
This Port Only
ESC INFO
– This Port Only: Selects only this port for a factory default action.
TIP: For a description of a selected menu item, press the INFO soft key.
7. Press the (Enter) key to display the warning pop-up box to reset
defaults.
Figure D.15 Warning Pop-Up Box to Reset Factory Defaults
Stopped AUTO
0.00 Hz F
WARNING
Use MOST to reset typical ▲
settings on this port
(preferred). Use ALL to
reset all settings. ▼
ESC ALL MOST
8. Press the MOST soft key to set MOST settings for the selected port
device to factory defaults. In this case, refer to the port device User
Manuals for the settings that will NOT be restored. Press the ALL soft
key to set ALL settings for the selected port device to factory defaults. Or
press the ESC soft key to cancel.
6. Press the (Enter) key to display the Set Defaults pop-up box.
Figure D.16 Set Defaults Pop-Up Box
Stopped AUTO
0.00 Hz F
WARNING
Sets all parameters to
factory defaults. Continue?
ESC ENTER
7. Press the ENTER soft key to affirm and set all device parameter values to
factory defaults. Or press the ESC soft key to cancel.
Specifications
Table E.A Universal Feedback Option Module LED Indication
LED Name Color State Description
20-750-UFB-1 ➊ Board Unlit Off Not powered.
➊
➋ Green Flashing Initializing, not active.
Communication lost, attempting to reconnect.
Steady Operational, no faults are present.
Red Flashing Module error.
• Check P1 [Module Status]
Steady Normal operation.
Module is booting.
Fatal module error.
• Cycle power
• Flash update module firmware
• Replace module
Yellow Flashing A type 2 alarm condition exists.
• Check P1 [Module Status]
Steady A type 1 alarm condition exists.
• Check P1 [Module Status]
Yellow / Flashing Module is flash updating.
Green Alternately
➋ DPI Unlit Off Not powered. Not communicating.
Green Flashing Module is attempting to communicate with the
DPI host.
Steady • Properly connected and communicating.
• Module is flash updating.
Red Flashing Module is not communicating with the DPI host.
Steady DPI communication failure such as invalid port.
Yellow Flashing Normal operation.
Steady Peripheral is connected to a SCANport product
and does not support a SCANport compatibility
mode.
Table E.B Universal Feedback Option Module DIP Switch Settings (Safety
Application)
Safety Channel Selection DIP Switch Settings
Primary Safety Channel
To connect feedback signals to the Primary Safety Channel, set: S1 S2 S3
S1 sliders to ON
S2 sliders to OFF
S3 slider to ON
Terminal Block Table E.C Universal Feedback Encoder Option Module TB1 Terminal Designations
Designations Terminal Name Description
-Sn +Sn -Sn Sine (–) Negative Sine signal
-Cs +Cs +Sn Sine (+) Positive Sine signal
IS OS
-Xc +Xc -Cs Cosine (–) Negative Cosine signal
-Xd +Xd +Cs Cosine (+) Positive Cosine signal
-Hf +Hf
5c +5 Is Inner Shield Heidenhain inner shield terminal
12c +12 Os Outer Shield Cable shield terminal
-A A -Xc Channel X Clock (–) Negative clock terminal (Channel X)
-B B
-Z Z +Xc Channel X Clock (+) Positive clock terminal (Channel X)
-Xd Channel X Data (–) Negative data terminal (Channel X)
+Xd Channel X Data (+) Positive data terminal (Channel X)
-Hf Heidenhain Supply Feedback (–)
+Hf Heidenhain Supply Feedback (+)
5c Common +5V Common
+5 +5 Volt DC Power Power supply for encoder 250 mA
12c Common +12V Common
+12 +12 Volt DC Power Power supply for encoder 250 mA
-A Encoder A (NOT) Single channel or quadrature A input or
A Encoder A encoder output.
-B Encoder B (NOT) Quadrature B input or encoder output.
B Encoder B
-Z Encoder Z (NOT) Pulse, marker or registration input or
Z Encoder Z encoder output.
Table E.D Universal Feedback Encoder Option Module TB2 Terminal Designations
Terminal Name Description
-Hm +Hm -Hm Home Input (–) Captures the AB edge counter.
-R0 +R0 +Hm Home Input (+) 12V to 24V DC
-R1 +R1
-Yc +Yc
-R0 Registration Input 0 (–) Positive and negative encoder
-Yd +Yd +R0 Registration Input 0 (+) registration terminals.
-R1 Registration Input 1 (–) 12V DC @ 9 mA to 24V DC @ 40 mA
+R1 Registration Input 1 (+)
-Yc Channel Y Clock (–) Negative clock terminal (Channel Y)
+Yc Channel Y Clock (+) Positive clock terminal (Channel Y)
-Yd Channel Y Data (–) Negative data terminal (Channel Y)
+Yd Channel Y Data (+) Positive data terminal (Channel Y)
Important: Only one linear feedback device can be connected to the option
module. Wire the device to either Channel X on TB1 or
Channel Y on TB2.
Parameter Access
Parameter Descriptions
Wiring Examples The following table includes a list of motor, feedback device and cable
wiring examples.
If you are using this motor and/or feedback device… and this cable… See this wiring example…
Heidenhain EnDat angle encoder (e.g., RCN729/829) with internal power supplied with encoder Figure E.1 on page E-5
supply
Heidenhain EnDat angle encoder with external power supply supplied with encoder Figure E.2 on page E-5
Heidenhain Non-EnDat rotary encoder with internal power supply PUR cable supplied with encoder Figure E.3 on page E-6
Heidenhain EnDat rotary encoder (ECN 412 EnDat01) with internal power supplied with encoder Figure E.4 on page E-6
supply
Heidenhain EnDat rotary encoder (ECN 412 EnDat01) with internal power PUR cable supplied with encoder Figure E.5 on page E-7
supply
460V MP series motor and Stegmann rotary encoder 2090-CDNFDMP-SXX Figure E.6 on page E-7
2090-XXNFMP-SXX Figure E.7 on page E-8
Allen-Bradley 1326AB-BXXXX-M2L, -M2KXL, -S2l or -S2KXL motor and 2090-CDNFDMP-SXX Figure E.6 on page E-7
Stegmann rotary encoder 2090-XXNFMP-SXX Figure E.7 on page E-8
230V MP series motor and a Stegmann rotary encoder 2090-UXNFDMP-SXX Figure E.8 on page E-8
2090-XXNFMP-SXX Figure E.9 on page E-9
Stegmann rotary encoder 1326-CECU-XXL-XXX Figure E.10 on page E-9
Pre-attached, shielded, twisted pair Figure E.11 on page E-10
Shielded, twisted pair cable with an Figure E.12 on page E-10
8-pin Berg style connector
Shielded, twisted pair cable with a Figure E.13 on page E-11
10-pin MS style connector
Shielded, twisted pair cable with a Figure E.14 on page E-11
12-pin DIN style connector
460V MP series motor and a rotary encoder 2090-CDNFDMP-SXX Figure E.15 on page E-12
2090-XXNFMP-SXX Figure E.15 on page E-12
Allen-Bradley 1326AB-BXXXX-M2L, -S2l or -S2KXL motor and a rotary 2090-XXNFMP-SXX Figure E.15 on page E-12
encoder
230V MP series motor and a rotary encoder 2090-UXNFDMP-SXX Figure E.16 on page E-12
2090-XXNFMP-SXX Figure E.16 on page E-12
Linear sensor MDI RG Connector Figure E.17 on page E-13
P Integral Cable Figure E.17 on page E-13
Registration sensor supplied with sensor Figure E.18 on page E-14
Simulated Incremental encoder output customer supplied Figure E.19 on page E-15
Figure E.1 Heidenhain EnDat Angle Encoder with Internal Power Supply
Universal Feedback Option Heidenhain EnDat
Module TB1 Encoder TB
RD/BK RD/BK
-Sn 1 13 B-
BL/BK BL/BK
+Sn 2 12 B+
YL/BK YL/BK
-Cs 3 16 A-
GN/BK GN/BK
+Cs 4 15 A+
IS 5 11 Inner Shld
OS 6 Outer Shld
YL YL
-Xc 7 9 CLK/
VI VI
+Xc 8 8 CLK
-Xd 9 PK PK
17 DATA/
GY GY
+Xd 10 14 DATA
WH WH
-Hf 11 4 SUP_FDBK-
BL BL
+Hf 12 1 SUP_FDBK+
WH/GN WH/GN
5c 13 10 SUP_V-
BN/GN BN/GN
+5 14 7 SUP_V+
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
Note: Refer to Installation Instructions supplied with encoder for additional information.
Figure E.2 Heidenhain EnDat Angle Encoder with External Power Supply
Universal Feedback Option Heidenhain EnDat
Module TB1 Encoder TB
RD/BK RD/BK
-Sn 1 13 B-
BL/BK BL/BK
+Sn 2 12 B+
YL/BK YL/BK
-Cs 3 16 A-
GN/BK GN/BK
+Cs 4 15 A+
IS 5 11 Inner Shld
OS 6 Outer Shld
YL YL
-Xc 7 9 CLK/
VI VI
+Xc 8 8 CLK
-Xd 9 PK PK
17 DATA/
GY GY
+Xd 10 14 DATA
WH WH
-Hf 11 4 SUP_FDBK-
BL BL
+Hf 12 1 SUP_FDBK+
WH/GN
5c 13 10 SUP_V-
BN/GN
+5 14 7 SUP_V+
15
16 Power+
17 Power-
18 Sense+
Sense-
19
20 Power Supply
21
22
Notes: Refer to Installation Instructions supplied with encoder for additional information. The external
power supply must be 3.6V to 5.25V, max. 350mA.
TB1-14 (Power+) and TB1-13 (Power-) must not be connected to the encoder. The brown/green and
white/green conductors must be connected to the external power supply. If the external power supply
does not have sense connections, the supply feedback (sense) connections should still be made from
the encoder to the universal board (TB1-11,12).
Figure E.3 Heidenhain Non-EnDat Rotary Encoder with Internal Power Supply
Universal Feedback Option Heidenhain Non-EnDat
Module TB1 Encoder TB
RD/BK RD/BK
-Sn 1 1 B-
BL/BK BL/BK
+Sn 2 8 B+
YL/BK YL/BK A-
-Cs 3 6
GN/BK GN/BK
+Cs 4 5 A+
IS 5 Inner Shld
OS 6 Outer Shld
-Xc CLK/
+Xc CLK
-Xd DATA/
+Xd DATA
WH WH
-Hf 11 11 SUP_FDBK-
BL
+Hf 12 BL 2 SUP_FDBK+
WH/Gn WH/GN
5c 13 10 SUP_V-
BL/Gn BN/GN
+5 14 12 SUP_V+
12c
+12
Note: Refer to Installation Instructions supplied with encoder for additional information.
Figure E.4 Heidenhain EnDat Rotary Encoder (ECN 412 EnDat01) with Internal
Power Supply
Universal Feedback Option Heidenhain EnDat
Module TB1 Encoder TB
RD/BK RD/BK
-Sn 1 13 B-
BL/BK BL/BK
+Sn 2 12 B+
YL/BK YL/BK
-Cs 3 16 A-
GN/BK GN/BK
+Cs 4 15 A+
IS 5 11 Inner Shld
OS 6 Outer Shld
YL YL
-Xc 7 9 CLK/
VI VI
+Xc 8 8 CLK
-Xd 9 PK PK
17 DATA/
GY GY
+Xd 10 14 DATA
WH WH
-Hf 11 4 SUP_FDBK-
BL BL
+Hf 12 1 SUP_FDBK+
WH/GN WH/GN
5c 13 10 SUP_V-
BN/GN BN/GN
+5 14 7 SUP_V+
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
Note: Refer to Installation Instructions supplied with encoder for additional information.
Figure E.5 Heidenhain EnDat Rotary Encoder (ECN 412 EnDat01) with Internal
Power Supply
Universal Feedback Option Heidenhain EnDat
Module TB1 Encoder TB
RD/BK RD/BK
-Sn 1 13 B-
BL/BK BL/BK
+Sn 2 12 B+
YL/BK YL/BK
-Cs 3 16 A-
GN/BK GN/BK
+Cs 4 15 A+
IS 5 11 Inner Shld
OS 6 Outer Shld
YL YL
-Xc 7 9 CLK/
VI VI
+Xc 8 8 CLK
-Xd 9 PK PK
17 DATA/
GY GY
+Xd 10 14 DATA
WH WH
-Hf 11 4 SUP_FDBK-
BL BL
+Hf 12 1 SUP_FDBK+
WH/GN WH/GN
5c 13 10 SUP_V-
BN/GN BN/GN
+5 14 7 SUP_V+
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
Note: Refer to Installation Instructions supplied with encoder for additional information.
BK/WH BK/WH
-Sn 1 B REFSIN
BK BK
+Sn 2 A +SIN
WH/RD WH/RD REFCOS
-Cs 3 D
RD RD
+Cs 4 C +COS
IS 5
OS 6
-Xc 7
+Xc 8
WH/GN WH/GN
-Xd 9 F DATA- (RS485)
GN GN
+Xd 10 E DATA+ (RS485)
-Hf 11 SHIELD
+Hf 12 OVERALL SHIELD
5c 13
+5 14
WH/OR WH/OR
12c 15 P POWER COMMON
OR
+12 16 OR
N POWER
BU BU
17 R TS+
WH/BU WH/BU
18 S TS-
19
20
21
22
BK/WH BK/WH
-Sn 1 B REFSIN
BK BK
+Sn 2 A +SIN
WH/RD WH/RD REFCOS
-Cs 3 D
RD RD
+Cs 4 C +COS
IS 5
OS 6
-Xc 7
+Xc 8
WH/GN WH/GN
-Xd 9 F DATA- (RS485)
GN GN
+Xd 10 E DATA+ (RS485)
-Hf 11 SHIELD
+Hf 12 OVERALL SHIELD
5c 13
+5 14
WH/GY WH/GY
12c 15 P POWER COMMON
OR
+12 16 OR
N POWER
17 R TS+
18 S TS-
19
20
21
22
Note: The Thermal Switch cannot be accessed using the 2090-XXNFMP-SXX cable.
Figure E.8 230V MP Series Motor and a Stegmann Rotary Encoder connected via a
2090-UXNFDMP-SXX Cable
Universal Feedback Option Stegmann
Module TB1 Encoder TB
BK/WH BK/WH
-Sn 1 B REFSIN
BK BK
+Sn 2 A +SIN
WH/RD WH/RD REFCOS
-Cs 3 D
RD RD
+Cs 4 C +COS
IS 5
OS 6
-Xc 7
+Xc 8
WH/GN WH/GN
-Xd 9 F DATA- (RS485)
GN GN
+Xd 10 E DATA+ (RS485)
-Hf 11 SHIELD
+Hf 12 OVERALL SHIELD
5c 13
+5 14
WH/GY WH/GY
12c 15 L POWER COMMON
GY
+12 16 GY
K POWER
BU BU
17 R TS+
WH/BU WH/BU
18 S TS-
19
20
21
22
Figure E.9 230V MP Series Motor and a Stegmann Rotary Encoder connected via a
2090-XXNFMP-SXX Cable
Universal Feedback Option Stegmann
Module TB1 Encoder TB
BK/WH BK/WH
-Sn 1 B REFSIN
BK BK
+Sn 2 A +SIN
WH/RD WH/RD REFCOS
-Cs 3 D
RD RD
+Cs 4 C +COS
IS 5
OS 6
-Xc 7
+Xc 8
WH/GN WH/GN
-Xd 9 F DATA- (RS485)
GN GN
+Xd 10 E DATA+ (RS485)
-Hf 11 SHIELD
+Hf 12 OVERALL SHIELD
5c 13
+5 14
WH/GY WH/GY
12c 15 L POWER COMMON
+12 16 GY GY
K POWER
17 R TS+
18 S TS-
19
20
21
22
Note: The Thermal Switch cannot be accessed using the 2090-XXNFMP-SXX cable.
BK BK
-Sn 1 C REFSIN
RD RD
+Sn 2 D +SIN
BK BK REFCOS
-Cs 3 E
BU BU
+Cs 4 F +COS
IS 5
OS 6
-Xc 7
+Xc 8
GN GN
-Xd 9 H DATA- (RS485)
BK BK
+Xd 10 G DATA+ (RS485)
-Hf 11 I SHIELD
+Hf 12 J OVERALL SHIELD
5c 13
+5 14
WH WH
12c 15 B POWER COMMON
+12 16 BK BK
A POWER
17
18
19
20
21
22
BN BN
-Sn 1 3 REFSIN
WH WH
+Sn 2 7 +SIN
BK BK REFCOS
-Cs 3 4
PK PK
+Cs 4 8 +COS
IS 5
OS 6
-Xc 7
+Xc 8
GN GN
-Xd 9 6 DATA- (RS485)
GY GY
+Xd 10 5 DATA+ (RS485)
-Hf 11
+Hf 12
5c 13
+5 14
BU BU
12c 15 2 POWER COMMON
+12 16 RD RD
1 POWER
17
18
19
20
21
22
Figure E.12 Stegmann Rotary Encoder Connected via a Shielded, Twisted Pair
Cable with an 8-pin Berg Style Connector
Universal Feedback Option Stegmann
Module TB1 Encoder TB
BN BN
-Sn 1 3 REFSIN
WH WH
+Sn 2 7 +SIN
BK BK REFCOS
-Cs 3 4
PK PK
+Cs 4 8 +COS
IS 5
OS 6
-Xc 7
+Xc 8
GN GN
-Xd 9 6 DATA- (RS485)
GY GY
+Xd 10 5 DATA+ (RS485)
-Hf 11
+Hf 12
5c 13
+5 14
BU BU
12c 15 2 POWER COMMON
+12 16 RD RD
1 POWER
17
18
19
20
21
22
Figure E.13 Stegmann Rotary Encoder Connected via a Shielded, Twisted Pair
Cable with a 10-pin MS Style Connector
Universal Feedback Option Stegmann
Module TB1 Encoder TB
BN BN
-Sn 1 C REFSIN
WH WH
+Sn 2 G +SIN
BK BK REFCOS
-Cs 3 D
PK PK
+Cs 4 H +COS
IS 5
OS 6
-Xc 7
+Xc 8
GN GN
-Xd 9 F DATA- (RS485)
GY GY
+Xd 10 E DATA+ (RS485)
-Hf 11
+Hf 12 J OVERALL SHIELD
5c 13
+5 14
BU BU
12c 15 B POWER COMMON
+12 16 RD RD
A POWER
17
18 I N/C
19
20
21
22
Figure E.14 Stegmann Rotary Encoder Connected via a Shielded, Twisted Pair
Cable with a 12-pin DIN Style Connector
Universal Feedback Option Stegmann
Module TB1 Encoder TB
BN BN
-Sn 1 6 REFSIN
WH WH
+Sn 2 5 +SIN
BK BK
-Cs 3 1 REFCOS
PK PK
+Cs 4 8 +COS
IS 5 11 N/C
OS 6 4 N/C
-Xc 7 3 N/C
+Xc 8
GN GN
-Xd 9 7 DATA- (RS485)
GY GY
+Xd 10 2 DATA+ (RS485)
-Hf 11
+Hf 12 9 OVERALL SHIELD
5c 13
+5 14
BU BU
12c 15 10 POWER COMMON
+12 16 RD RD
12 POWER
17
18
19
20
21
22
Figure E.15 460V MP Series Motor and a Rotary Encoder Connected via a
2090-CDNFDMP-SXX or 2090-XXNFMP-SXX Cable or Allen-Bradley
1326AB-BXXXX-M2L, -S2l or -S2KXL Motor and a Rotary Encoder Connected via a
2090-XXNFMP-SXX Cable
Universal Feedback Option Rotary
Module TB1 Encoder TB
BK/WH BK/WH
-Sn 1 B REFSIN
BK BK
+Sn 2 A +SIN
WH/RD WH/RD REFCOS
-Cs 3 D
RD RD
+Cs 4 C +COS
IS 5
OS 6
-Xc 7
+Xc 8
WH/GN WH/GN
-Xd 9 F DATA- (RS485)
GN GN
+Xd 10 E DATA+ (RS485)
-Hf 11 SHIELD
+Hf 12 OVERALL SHIELD
5c 13
+5 14
WH/OR WH/OR
12c 15 P POWER COMMON
OR
+12 16 OR
N POWER
BU BU
17 R TS+
WH/BU WH/BU
18 S TS-
19
20
21
22
Figure E.16 230V MP Series Motor and a Rotary Encoder Connected via a
2090-UXNFDMP-SXX or 2090-XXNFMP-SXX Cable
Universal Feedback Option Rotary
Module TB1 Encoder TB
BK/WH BK/WH
-Sn 1 B REFSIN
BK BK
+Sn 2 A +SIN
WH/RD WH/RD REFCOS
-Cs 3 D
RD RD
+Cs 4 C +COS
IS 5
OS 6
-Xc 7
+Xc 8
WH/GN WH/GN
-Xd 9 F DATA- (RS485)
GN GN
+Xd 10 E DATA+ (RS485)
-Hf 11 SHIELD
+Hf 12 OVERALL SHIELD
5c 13
+5 14
WH/GY WH/GY
12c 15 L POWER COMMON
GY
+12 16 GY
K POWER
BU BU
17 R TS+
WH/BU WH/BU
18 S TS-
19
20
21
22
-Hm 1
+Hm 2
-R0 3
+R0 4
-R1 5 Linear Sensor
6 TB
+R1
GN YE
-Yc 7 3 (+) Clock
YE GN
+Yc 8 4 (-) Clock
PK PK 1 (-) Data
-Yd 9
GY GY
+Yd 10 2 (+) Data
RD or BN
5 +24V DC
Universal Feedback Option WH
6 DC Ground
Module TB1 7 N/C
24V DC Power Supply
RD or BN
-Sn 1 + Power
+Sn 2 WH
- Common
-Cs 3
+Cs 4
IS 5
OS 6
-Xc 7
+Xc 8
-Xd 9
+Xd 10
-Hf 11
+Hf 12
5c 13
+5 14
12c 15
+12 16
17
18
19
20
21
22
-Sn 1 Common
+Sn 2
External
-Cs 3 Power
+Cs 4 Supply
IS 5 12 or 24V DC
OS 6
-Xc 7
+Xc 8
-Xd 9
+Xd 10
-Hf 11
+Hf 12
5c 13
+5 14
12c 15
+12 16
17
18
19
20
21
22
-Sn 1
+Sn 2
-Cs 3
+Cs 4
IS 5
OS 6
-Xc 7
+Xc 8
-Xd 9
+Xd 10
-Hf 11
+Hf 12
5c 13
+5 14
12c 15
Customer Equipment
+12 16
-A 17
A 18
-B 19
B 20
-Z 21
Z 22
PE
Notes:
Parameter Access
Parameter Descriptions
Dual Encoder
Table F.C Dual Incremental Encoder Jumper Settings
Jumper Enabled Position Storage Position
20-750-DENC-1
P3 - Safety Jumper
Enables use with
P3 P3
speed monitoring
safety option
(20-750-S1).
P4 - 12V Jumper
Enables use with 12
volt supply.
P4 P4
Parameter Access
Parameter Descriptions
Sh Shield
12V Enc +12V
Com Enc Ret
5V Enc +5V
A Enc A
A- /Enc A
B Enc B
B- /Enc B
Z Enc Z
Z- /Enc Z
+24V
24VC
HmC
Hm
Sh Shield
12V Enc +12V
Com Enc Ret
5V Enc +5V
A Enc A
A- /Enc A
B Enc B
B- /Enc B
Z Enc Z
Z- /Enc Z
+24V
24VC
HmC
Hm
Figure F.3 Differential Dual Channel with Z Channel with External Power Supply
Common
Encoder
+ Power Supply
Shield
Single Incremental Encoder Encoder TB
Option Module TB
Sh Shield
12V Enc +12V
Com Enc Ret
5V Enc +5V
A Enc A
A- /Enc A
B Enc B
B- /Enc B
Z Enc Z
Z- /Enc Z
+24V
24VC
HmC
Hm
Sh Shield
12V Enc +12V
Com Enc Ret
5V Enc +5V
A Enc A
A- /Enc A
B Enc B
B- /Enc B
Z Enc Z
Z- /Enc Z
+24V
24VC
HmC
Hm
ES Enc +12V
EC Enc Ret
0A Enc A
0A- /Enc A
0B Enc B
0B- /Enc B
0Z Enc Z
0Z- /Enc Z
Sd Shield
Sd
ES Enc +12V
EC Enc Ret
1A Enc A
1A- /Enc A
1B Enc B
1B- /Enc B
1Z Enc Z
1Z- /Enc Z
24 Shield
24C
Secondary
Hm Encoder TB
HmC
Notes:
Using DeviceLogix
Only the drive software tools listed above can be used to program the
DeviceLogix component in the PowerFlex 750-Series drive. Other
DeviceLogix Editors, such as RSNetWorx for DeviceNet, cannot be used.
Parameters The following are the DeviceLogix parameters (located in Port 14).
Read-Write
Data Type
Digital Inputs Analog Inputs Analog Outputs Group
Name
File
Options
DLX DIPVal9
DLX DIPVal8
DLX DIPVal7
DLX DIPVal6
DLX DIPVal5
DLX DIPVal4
DLX DIPVal3
DLX DIPVal2
DLX DIPVal1
HOST GROUPS
Options
Status & Cntl
DLX CmdSts9
DLX CmdSts8
DLX CmdSts7
DLX CmdSts6
DLX CmdSts5
DLX CmdSts4
DLX CmdSts3
DLX CmdSts2
DLX CmdSts1
Options
DLX DOPSts9
DLX DOPSts8
DLX DOPSts7
DLX DOPSts6
DLX DOPSts5
DLX DOPSts4
DLX DOPSts3
DLX DOPSts2
DLX DOPSts1
Read-Write
Data Type
Group
Name
File
3 = “Save Program”
4 = “Load Program”
5 = “Logic Disabled”
6 = “Logic Enabled”
54 DLX Real SP1 Default: 0 RW 32-bit
Thru Min/Max: –/+220000000 Integer
69 DLX Real SP16
Sixteen 32-bit Real scratchpad registers for DLX program use.
Internal Regs
Function Block Elements The following function block elements are available:
Filter
Select/Limit
Statistical
Timer/Counter
Compare
Compute/Math
Move/Logical
(1)
Bit and Analog I/O do not count against the Function Block total (90
max.). All other elements count, with each instance counting as one
Function Block.
Bit Inputs
Available bit inputs to the DeviceLogix program include:
Bit Inputs Description
(16) Hardware Boolean Inputs These correlate with DeviceLogix Port 14 parameters P33 [DLX DIP
• DIP1 to DIP 16 01] to P48 [DLX DIP 16]
(32) Network Boolean Inputs These correlate with the DeviceLogix Logic Status word for the drive.
• Ready, Active, Alarm, Faulted, etc. Refer to page A-8 for details on the Logic Status word bits.
Bit Outputs
Available bit outputs from the DeviceLogix program include:
Bit Outputs Description
(16) Hardware Boolean Outputs These correlate with the bits in DeviceLogix Port 14 parameter Pr. 51
• DOP1 to DOP 16 [DLX DigOut Sts2]
(32) Network Boolean Outputs These correlate with the DeviceLogix Logic Command word for the
• Stop, Start, Jog1, Clear Faults, etc. drive. Refer to page A-7 for details on the Logic Command word bits.
These bits can also be monitored in DeviceLogix Port 14 parameter
Pr. 50 [DLX DigOut Sts].
Bit Outputs are used to connect to real-world output devices (pilot lights,
relays, etc.) that are wired to an I/O option module in the drive, to directly
control the drive via Logic Command bits, or to write a bit in a
bit-enumerated parameter.
Analog Inputs
Available analog inputs to the DeviceLogix program include:
Analog Inputs Description
(17) Network Analog Inputs The Common Feedback correlates with the Feedback word for the
• Common Feedback (Real) drive. The DLX In’s correlate with DeviceLogix Port 14 parameters Pr.
17 [DLX In 01] to Pr.32 [DLX In 16]
• DLX In 01 to DLX In 14 (Real)
• DLX In 15 to DLX In 16 (DINT)
(7) Miscellaneous Analog Inputs Year, Month, Day, DayofWeek, Hour, Minute, and Second from the
• Real Time Clock data Real Time Clock in the drive
Analog Outputs
Available analog outputs from the DeviceLogix program include:
Analog Outputs Description
(17) Network Analog Outputs The Reference Command correlates with the Reference word for the
• Reference Command (Real) drive. The DLX Out’s correlate with DeviceLogix Port 14 parameters
Pr. 1 [DLX Out 01] to Pr.16 [DLX Out 16]
• DLX Out 01 to DLX Out 14 (Real)
• DLX Out 15 to DLX Out 16 (DINT)
Function Block elements also support different data types. Click on the
Properties Button in the upper right-hand corner of each element to
display the Function Block’s properties. The Function Data Type field
displays the supported data types. Note that if Real DLX Ins are used with a
Function Block element configured for DINT (typical default), the fraction
will be truncated.
DLX Real SP1 is read by DLX In 01 and can now be used as an Analog
Input in the DeviceLogix program.
DLX Real SP1 is the intermediary register that allows the two Datalinks to
work together.
DLX Real SP2 is the intermediary register that allows the two Datalinks to
work together.
The truth table below represents the inputs and outputs for a 4 position
selector switch.
Inputs Outputs
Input 1 Input 2 Binary Output Selector Switch
Output
0 0 0 Output A
0 1 1 Output B
1 0 2 Output C
1 1 3 Output D
The Logic Map below offers a high level explanation of how the above
outputs are achieved.
Figure G.1 Two Input Four Position Selector Switch Logic Map
Digital Input 1 00
DLX
DIP 1 Output A
01
Output B
DLX
Out 1
10 Output C
Digital Input 2
DLX Output D
DIP 2 11
Discrete Inputs in the Drive are used for Inputs 1 and Input 2. Output A, B,
C, and D are linked to DeviceLogix Scratchpad Registers. This allows
further flexibility to modify the values of these outputs.
Parameter Configuration
14 SEL
13 BAND
Select
11 BNOT 12 BNOT 1
Boolean And EnableIn
1 75.000000 75.000000
Boolean Not Boolean Not EnableIn In1 DevLogix Out 01
1 1 1
EnableIn EnableIn In1 In2
shown below.
1 1
In In In2 SelectorIn
85.000000
DevLogix In 02
10 SEL
2 BOR 3 BAND 9 BAND
Select
1
Boolean Or Boolean And Boolean And EnableIn
Functional Block Programming
1 1 1 0.000000
EnableIn EnableIn EnableIn In1
0 0 0
In1 In1 In1 In2
In2 In2 In2 SelectorIn
95.000000
DevLogix In 03
8 SEL
0 4 BAND 7 BAND
DIP 2 Select
1
Boolean And Boolean And EnableIn
1 1 0.000000
EnableIn EnableIn In1
0 0
In1 In1 In2
105.000000 5 SEL
DevLogix In 04
0 1 BAND
DIP 1 Select
6 BNOT 1
Boolean And EnableIn
1 0.000000
EnableIn Boolean Not In1
0 1
In1 EnableIn In2
Using DeviceLogix
1
The Selector Switch Operation example consists of 14 blocks that are
In2 In SelectorIn
G-9
Scale In Hi determines the high value for the input to the scale block.
Scale Out Hi determines the corresponding high value for the output of the
scale block.
Scale In Low determines the low value for the input to the scale block.
Scale Out Lo determines the corresponding low value for the output of the
scale block.
Scale Out Value of the block is then available for user to link to any
parameter that accepts links.
Parameter Configuration
4 SEL
In2
Select SelectorIn
3 LEQ 1
EnableIn
0.000000 0.000000
Less Than or Eql (A<=B) DevLogix In 01 In1
1 0.000000
EnableIn DevLogix In 02 In2
Scale In Low 1
SourceA SelectorIn
0.000000
DevLogix In 02 SourceB
Functional Block Programming
6 SUB
Subtract
1
EnableIn
0.000000
SourceA
9 DIV
SourceB
Scale Input Span
Divide
7 SUB 1
EnableIn
0.000000
Subtract SourceA
Scale In High 1
EnableIn SourceB
1800.000000 1800.000000
DevLogix In 03 SourceA
0.000000
DevLogix In 02 SourceB
10 ABS 11 MUL 12 ADD
Scale In Low Scale Output Span
Absolute Value Multiply Add
8 SUB 1 0 0 Scale Out Value
EnableIn EnableIn EnableIn
0.000000 0.000000 0.000000 0.000000
Subtract Source SourceA SourceA DevLogix Out 01
Scale Out High 1
EnableIn SourceB SourceB
0.000000 10.000000
DevLogix In 05 SourceA
0.000000
DevLogix In 04 SourceB
Sensor
Diverter
Upstream Converyor
Downstream Converyor
Parameter Configuration
Flip-Flop circuit
1st time ON / 2nd time OFF on so on
Parts Counter
1 CTU 2 BAND 4 SETD
Part Present Output to control
Photoeye Count Up Boolean And Set Dominant the diverter
1 1 1
EnableIn EnableIn EnableIn
0 0 0 0 0
DIP 1 CUEnable In1 Set DOP 1
3 BAND
Boolean And
1 Because loop-back is performed,
EnableIn ">>" is used to determine order
0
In1
In2
Inflow
Outflow
• If Critical High Level or High Level sensor is ON, then start the drive.
– If Critical High Level sensor is ON, then switch to higher rate (90Hz)
for the rest of the pumping cycle. Else run at the normal rate (60Hz)
– Run until all three level sensors are OFF
– Pump should run at least ‘x’ minutes at a minimum. If the Low Level
sensor fails, this prevents the High Level sensor from cycling the
pump On/Off too quickly.
• Annunciate a Sensor Fault condition
– The Low Level sensor should never be OFF when either the High
Level or Critical High Level sensors are ON
– The High Level sensor should never be OFF when the Critical High
Level sensor is ON
– The Critical High Level sensor should never be ON when either the
High Level or Low Level sensors are OFF
• Annunciate a Critical High Level condition
– The Critical High Level output should never be ON
• Annunciate if pumping cycle time is longer than normal (‘y’ minutes)
– Monitor the amount of time a pump cycle takes by timing how long
the drive is operating.
– If greater than ‘y’ minutes, energize the Too Much Time Alarm
output
• Reset alarms / faults with a Reset pushbutton input
Parameter Configuration
SpdRef Sel 0
8 SETD
Set Dominant
Run at High Rate
EnableIn
Figure G.4 Control Circuit
Sensor
Stop is momentarily
DIP 2
asserted ( 2 secs)
3 TONR
EnableIn
This example consists of 16 blocks that are shown below.
Active TimerEnable
Reset
Using DeviceLogix
10 BAND
Low Level
Sensor Boolean And
EnableIn
DIP 3 In1
In2
12 BOR 13 SETD
9 BOR
Boolean Or Set Dominant
Critical High Sensor Fault
Level Sensor Boolean Or EnableIn EnableIn
EnableIn
High Level
Figure G.5 Fault/Alarm Circuit
Sensor In1
Allarm / Fault
Reset PB
DIP 4
14 SETD
Critical High
Set Dominant Level Fault
EnableIn
15 TONR 16 SETD
Too Much Time
Timer On Delay with Reset Set Dominant Alarm
EnableIn EnableIn
• Run the drive Monday through Friday between 7:45AM and 5:15PM
This example demonstrates how to utilize the PowerFlex 750-Series drive
Monday - Friday
2 LEQ 1
SpdRef Sel 0
Less Than or Eql (A<=B)
1
EnableIn
1
SourceA
SourceB
8:00 - 16:59
Grtr Than or Eql (A>=B) Boolean And Pulse Timer with Reset
0.571
0.545
1 1 1
EnableIn EnableIn EnableIn
9 1 1 0 0
Hour SourceA In1 TimerEnable Stop
5 LES
SourceB
Parameter
7:45 - 7:59
Preset Speed 1
13 BOR
Speed Ref A Sel
7 EQU 9 BAND
Boolean Or
1
Equal Boolean And EnableIn
1 1 1
Functional Block Programming
8 GEQ
13 0
Minute SourceA
SourceB
17:00 - 17:14
10 EQU 12 BAND
EnableIn EnableIn
The following parameters are configured for this example:
0 0
SourceA In1
SourceB In2
Description
11 LES
Using DeviceLogix
1
EnableIn
1
SourceA
SourceB
Notes:
Compatible Permanent The following table contains a list of specifications for the permanent
Magnet Motors magnet motors compatible with PowerFlex 750-Series drives. Note that you
must have a high resolution Stegmann or compatible resolver.
Table H.A Motor Name Plate and Rating Specifications
System Cont.
Motor NP Volts Motor NP Amps Motor NP Motor NP RPM Motor NP Motor Current peak Stall Torque Motor Max
Model Number (line to line V rms) (A rms) Hertz (Hz) (oper. rpm) Power (kW) Poles (A rms) (N•m) RPM (rpm)
Parameter # 25 26 27 28 30 31
MPL-A310P 230 3.4 294.0 4410 0.73 8 9.9, 1.58 5000
MPL-A310F 230 2.1 185.3 2780 0.46 8 6.6 1.58 3000
MPL-A320P 230 6.4 271.3 4070 1.30 8 20.9 3.05 5000
MPL-A320H 230 4.6 208.7 3130 1.00 8 13.6 3.05 3500
MPL-A330P 230 8.5 280.7 4210 1.80 8 26.9 4.08 5000
MPL-A420P 230 9.0 268.7 4030 2.00 8 32.5 4.74 5000
MPL-A430P 230 11.9 234.0 3510 2.20 8 47.4 5.99 5000
MPL-A430H 230 8.6 184.7 2770 1.80 8 31.8 6.21 3500
MPL-A4520P 230 12.4 234.0 3510 2.20 8 35.4 5.99 5000
MPL-A4520K 230 10.6 223.3 3350 2.10 8 30.4 5.99 4000
MPL-A4530F 230 9.5 144.7 2170 1.90 8 29.7 8.36 2800
MPL-A4530K 230 14.4 196.0 2940 2.50 8 43.8 8.13 4000
MPL-A4540C 230 6.6 93.3 1400 1.50 8 20.5 10.20 1500
MPL-A4540F 230 13.0 162.0 2430 2.60 8 38.2 10.20 3000
MPL-A520K 230 16.3 208.0 3120 3.50 8 46.0 10.70 4000
MPL-A540K 230 29.3 180.7 2710 5.50 8 84.9 19.40 4000
MPL-A560F 230 29.3 125.3 1880 5.50 8 84.9 27.90 3000
System Cont.
Motor NP Volts Motor NP Amps Motor NP Motor NP RPM Motor NP Motor Current peak Stall Torque Motor Max
Model Number (line to line V rms) (A rms) Hertz (Hz) (oper. rpm) Power (kW) Poles (A rms) (N•m) RPM (rpm)
MPL-B980C 460 48.2 67.3 1010 16.80 8 99.0 158.20 1500
MPL-B980D 460 63.6 74.7 1120 18.60 8 141.4 158.20 2000
A D
AC Input Distribution Systems 17
Circuit Breakers 9 Unbalanced 5
Line Fuses 9 Ungrounded 5
AC Supply Drive Frame Sizes 3
Source 5 Drive Ratings 9
Unbalanced 5 DriveLogix Controller 2
Ungrounded 5
Drives Support 2
AC Supply Source Consideration 5
Dynamic Brake
Agency Certification 1 Setup 40
Armored Cable 9 Dynamic Brake Resistor 16
B E
Brake EMC
Dynamic 40 Directive 37
Brake Resistor 16 EMI/RFI Filter Grounding, RFI Filter 7
Encoder Wiring 33
C
Cable Entry Plate F
SHLD Terminal 6
Filter, RFI 7
Cable Length
Frame Designations 9
Motor 10
Frame Sizes 3
Cable Trays 10
Fuses
Cables, Power
Ratings 9
Armored 9
Insulation 8
Separation 8 G
Shielded 8, 9 General Precautions 4
Type 8
Grounding
Unshielded 8, 9
Filter 7
Capacitors 17 Recommended Scheme 6
CE Conformity 37 Shields 6
Common Mode Capacitors 17 Grounding Requirements 6
Conduit 10
Conformity
I
CE 37
I/O Wiring 22
Contactors
Input/Output 16 Input Power Conditioning 5
Controller Input/Output Contactors
DriveLogix 2 Using 16
Conventions 3 Installation/Wiring
Chapter 1 1
Cover
Opening 2
M
Manual Conventions 3
Mode Capacitors 17 S
Motor 10 Scheme
Motor Cable Lengths 10 Recommended Grounding 6
MOV 5 Shielded Cables
MOVs 17 Power 9
SHLD Terminal 6
N Specifications
Agency Certification 1
National Codes and standards 8
Control 3
Drive Ratings 9
O Electrical 3
Environment 2
Opening
Protection 1
Cover 2
Supply Source 5
Opening the Cover 2
Support 2
P
T
Parameter
Linear List Format 17 Technical Support 2
Parameters 1 Terminal Block 11
About 1 Wire Size
Cross Reference 115 Power 11
Organization 3 THWN
Programming 1 THHN 9
PE 6
Permanent Magnet Motor Specifications 1 U
Permanent Magnet Motors Unbalanced/Ungrounded Supply 5
Compatible Motors 1
Ungrounded Distribution Systems 17
Motor Name Plate and Rating
Unshielded Power Cables 9
Specifications 1
Power 11
Power Conditioning, Input 5 W
Power Terminal Block 11 Wiring
Power Wiring 8 Encoder 33
Precautions 4 I/O 22
Power 8
R
Ratings, Drive 9
RCD
Residual Current Detector 5
Recommended Grounding Scheme 6
Reflected Wave 9
Residual Current Detector 5
Resistor
Brake 16
www.rockwellautomation.com